1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
5 <!-- current Debian changes file format -->
6 <!entity changesversion "1.8">
12 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
13 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
14 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
17 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
18 distribution. This includes the structure and
19 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
20 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
21 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
26 Copyright © 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
27 and Christian Schwarz.
30 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
31 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
32 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
37 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
38 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
39 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
40 2, or (at your option) any later version.
44 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
45 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
46 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
47 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
52 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
53 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian
54 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
55 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
56 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
57 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
58 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
66 <heading>About this manual</heading>
68 <heading>Scope</heading>
70 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
71 distribution. This includes the structure and
72 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
73 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
74 each package must satisfy to be included in the
79 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
80 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
81 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
82 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
83 attempts to define the interface to the package management
84 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
85 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
86 material meet one of the following requirements:
87 <taglist compact="compact">
88 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
90 The material presented represents an interface to
91 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
92 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
93 therefore should not be changed without peer
94 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
95 interface not changing, and the package management
96 software authors need to ensure compatibility with
97 this interface definition. (Control file and
98 changelog file formats are examples.)
100 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
102 If there are a number of technically viable choices
103 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
104 these options for inter-operability. The version
105 number format is one example.
108 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
109 selected conventions often become parts of standard
115 The footnotes present in this manual are
116 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
120 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
121 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
125 In the normative part of this manual,
126 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
127 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
128 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
129 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
130 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
131 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
132 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
133 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
134 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
135 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
136 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
137 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
138 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
142 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
143 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
144 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
145 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
146 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
147 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
150 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
151 used in a different way in this document.
156 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
157 useful even when building a package which is to be
158 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
163 udebs (stripped-down binary packages used by the Debian Installer) do
164 not comply with all of the requirements discussed here. See the
165 <url name="Debian Installer internals manual"
166 id="http://d-i.alioth.debian.org/doc/internals/ch03.html"> for more
167 information about them.
172 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
175 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
176 <package><url name="debian-policy"
177 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
178 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
179 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
183 The current version of this document is also available from
184 the Debian web mirrors at
185 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
186 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
188 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
189 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
190 Also available from the same directory are several other
191 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
192 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
193 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
194 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
195 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
196 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
200 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
201 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
202 changes between versions of this document.
207 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
210 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
211 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
212 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
213 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
214 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
215 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
216 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
220 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
221 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
222 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
223 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
224 consensus is established.
225 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
226 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
227 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
230 <item>Russ Allbery</item>
231 <item>Bill Allombert</item>
232 <item>Andrew McMillan</item>
233 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
234 <item>Colin Watson</item>
239 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
240 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
241 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
242 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
243 the Debian Policy List,
244 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
245 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
249 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
250 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
255 <heading>Related documents</heading>
258 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
259 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
264 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
265 <list compact="compact">
266 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
267 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
268 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
269 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
270 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
271 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
276 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
277 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
278 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
279 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
280 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
284 The Developer's Reference is available in the
285 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
286 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
287 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
288 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
292 Finally, a <qref id="copyrightformat">specification for
293 machine-readable copyright files</qref> is maintained as part of
294 the <package>debian-policy</package> package using the same
295 procedure as the other policy documents. Use of this format is
300 <sect id="definitions">
301 <heading>Definitions</heading>
304 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
308 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
309 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
310 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
311 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
312 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
316 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
317 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
318 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
319 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
320 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
330 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
333 The Debian system is maintained and distributed as a
334 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
335 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
336 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
337 the handling of them.
341 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
342 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
343 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
344 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
345 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
346 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
347 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
348 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
349 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
350 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
354 The aims of this are:
356 <list compact="compact">
357 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
358 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
360 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
361 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
362 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
367 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian distribution</em>.
371 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
372 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
373 distribution, although we support their use and provide
374 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
375 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
380 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
382 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
383 definition of "free software". These are:
385 <tag>1. Free Redistribution
388 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
389 party from selling or giving away the software as a
390 component of an aggregate software distribution
391 containing programs from several different
392 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
393 other fee for such sale.
398 The program must include source code, and must allow
399 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
401 <tag>3. Derived Works
404 The license must allow modifications and derived
405 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
406 same terms as the license of the original software.
408 <tag>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code
411 The license may restrict source-code from being
412 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
413 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
414 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
415 program at build time. The license must explicitly
416 permit distribution of software built from modified
417 source code. The license may require derived works to
418 carry a different name or version number from the
419 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
420 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
421 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
423 <tag>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
426 The license must not discriminate against any person
429 <tag>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
432 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
433 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
434 example, it may not restrict the program from being
435 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
438 <tag>7. Distribution of License
441 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
442 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
443 for execution of an additional license by those
446 <tag>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
449 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
450 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
451 program is extracted from Debian and used or
452 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
453 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
454 the program is redistributed must have the same
455 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
458 <tag>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
461 The license must not place restrictions on other
462 software that is distributed along with the licensed
463 software. For example, the license must not insist
464 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
465 must be free software.
467 <tag>10. Example Licenses
470 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
471 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
478 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
481 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
484 The <em>main</em> archive area comprises the Debian
485 distribution. Only the packages in this area are considered
486 part of the distribution. None of the packages in
487 the <em>main</em> archive area require software outside of
488 that area to function. Anyone may use, share, modify and
489 redistribute the packages in this archive area
491 See <url id="http://www.debian.org/intro/free"
492 name="What Does Free Mean?"> for
493 more about what we mean by free software.
498 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
499 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
503 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
504 <list compact="compact">
506 must not require or recommend a package outside
507 of <em>main</em> for compilation or execution (thus, the
508 package must not declare a "Pre-Depends", "Depends",
509 "Recommends", "Build-Depends", or "Build-Depends-Indep"
510 relationship on a non-<em>main</em> package),
513 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
517 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
526 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
529 The <em>contrib</em> archive area contains supplemental
530 packages intended to work with the Debian distribution, but
531 which require software outside of the distribution to either
536 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
540 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
541 <list compact="compact">
543 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
547 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
554 Examples of packages which would be included in
555 <em>contrib</em> are:
556 <list compact="compact">
558 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
559 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
560 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
564 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
571 <sect1 id="non-free">
572 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
575 The <em>non-free</em> archive area contains supplemental
576 packages intended to work with the Debian distribution that do
577 not comply with the DFSG or have other problems that make
578 their distribution problematic. They may not comply with all
579 of the policy requirements in this manual due to restrictions
580 on modifications or other limitations.
584 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
585 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
586 or other legal issues that make their distribution
591 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
592 <list compact="compact">
594 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
598 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
599 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
601 It is possible that there are policy
602 requirements which the package is unable to
603 meet, for example, if the source is
604 unavailable. These situations will need to be
605 handled on a case-by-case basis.
614 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
615 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
618 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
619 copyright information and distribution license in the file
620 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
621 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
625 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
626 anywhere in our archives if
627 <list compact="compact">
629 their use or distribution would break a law,
632 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
636 we would have to sign a license for them, or
639 their distribution would conflict with other project
646 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
647 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
648 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
649 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
650 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
654 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
655 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
656 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
657 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
662 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
663 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
664 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
665 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
666 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
667 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
668 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
669 permitted then nothing is permitted.
673 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
674 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
675 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
676 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
677 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
678 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
679 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
684 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
685 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
686 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
687 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
688 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
689 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
693 <sect id="subsections">
694 <heading>Sections</heading>
697 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
698 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
699 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
703 The archive area and section for each package should be
704 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
705 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
706 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
707 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
709 <list compact="compact">
711 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
712 <em>main</em> archive area,
715 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
716 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
723 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
724 list of sections. At present, they are:
780 The additional section <em>debian-installer</em>
781 contains special packages used by the installer and is not used
782 for normal Debian packages.
786 For more information about the sections and their definitions,
787 see the <url id="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/"
788 name="list of sections in unstable">.
792 <sect id="priorities">
793 <heading>Priorities</heading>
796 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
797 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
798 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
799 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
800 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
804 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
805 Debian package management tools.
807 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
809 Packages which are necessary for the proper
810 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
811 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
812 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
813 system to become totally broken and you may not even
814 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
815 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
816 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
817 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
818 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
820 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
822 Important programs, including those which one would
823 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
824 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
825 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
826 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
827 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
828 This is an important criterion because we are
829 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
832 Other packages without which the system will not run
833 well or be usable must also have priority
834 <tt>important</tt>. This does
835 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
836 or any other large applications. The
837 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
838 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
840 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
842 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
843 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
844 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
845 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
847 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
849 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
850 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
851 all the software that you might reasonably want to
852 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
853 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
854 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
855 distribution, and many applications. Note that
856 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
858 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
860 This contains all packages that conflict with others
861 with required, important, standard or optional
862 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
863 already know what they are or have specialized
864 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
871 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
872 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
873 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
882 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
885 The Debian distribution is based on the Debian
886 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
887 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
888 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
892 A <tt>.deb</tt> package contains two sets of files: a set of files
893 to install on the system when the package is installed, and a set
894 of files that provide additional metadata about the package or
895 which are executed when the package is installed or removed. This
896 second set of files is called <em>control information files</em>.
897 Among those files are the package maintainer scripts
898 and <file>control</file>, the <qref id="binarycontrolfiles">binary
899 package control file</qref> that contains the control fields for
900 the package. Other control information files include
901 the <qref id="sharedlibs-symbols"><file>symbols</file> file</qref>
902 or <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps"><file>shlibs</file> file</qref>
903 used to store shared library dependency information and
904 the <file>conffiles</file> file that lists the package's
905 configuration files (described in <ref id="config-files">).
909 There is unfortunately a collision of terminology here between
910 control information files and files in the Debian control file
911 format. Throughout this document, a <em>control file</em> refers
912 to a file in the Debian control file format. These files are
913 documented in <ref id="controlfields">. Only files referred to
914 specifically as <em>control information files</em> are the files
915 included in the control information file member of
916 the <file>.deb</file> file format used by binary packages. Most
917 control information files are not in the Debian control file
922 <heading>The package name</heading>
925 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
930 The package name is included in the control field
931 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
932 in <ref id="f-Package">.
933 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
934 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
939 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
942 Every package has a version number recorded in its
943 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
944 <ref id="f-Version">.
948 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
949 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
950 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
951 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
952 the one installed on the system. The version number format
953 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
954 concerned) at the beginning.
958 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
959 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
960 <tt>Version</tt> field.
964 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
967 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
968 numbers as the upstream sources. However, upstream version
969 numbers based on some date formats (sometimes used for
970 development or "snapshot" releases) will not be ordered
971 correctly by the package management software. For
972 example, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will consider "96May01" to be
973 greater than "96Dec24".
977 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
978 version, the date-based portion of any upstream version number
979 should be given in a way that sorts correctly: four-digit year
980 first, followed by a two-digit numeric month, followed by a
981 two-digit numeric date, possibly with punctuation between the
986 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been written
987 especially for Debian) whose version numbers include dates
988 should also follow these rules. If punctuation is desired
989 between the date components, remember that hyphen (<tt>-</tt>)
990 cannot be used in native package versions. Period
991 (<tt>.</tt>) is normally a good choice.
997 <sect id="maintainer">
998 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
1001 Every package must have a maintainer, except for orphaned
1002 packages as described below. The maintainer may be one person
1003 or a group of people reachable from a common email address, such
1004 as a mailing list. The maintainer is responsible for
1005 maintaining the Debian packaging files, evaluating and
1006 responding appropriately to reported bugs, uploading new
1007 versions of the package (either directly or through a sponsor),
1008 ensuring that the package is placed in the appropriate archive
1009 area and included in Debian releases as appropriate for the
1010 stability and utility of the package, and requesting removal of
1011 the package from the Debian distribution if it is no longer
1012 useful or maintainable.
1016 The maintainer must be specified in the <tt>Maintainer</tt>
1017 control field with their correct name and a working email
1018 address. The email address given in the <tt>Maintainer</tt>
1019 control field must accept mail from those role accounts in
1020 Debian used to send automated mails regarding the package. This
1021 includes non-spam mail from the bug-tracking system, all mail
1022 from the Debian archive maintenance software, and other role
1023 accounts or automated processes that are commonly agreed on by
1024 the project.<footnote>
1025 A sample implementation of such a whitelist written for the
1026 Mailman mailing list management software is used for mailing
1027 lists hosted by alioth.debian.org.
1029 If one person or team maintains several packages, they should
1030 use the same form of their name and email address in
1031 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
1035 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
1036 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
1040 If the maintainer of the package is a team of people with a
1041 shared email address, the <tt>Uploaders</tt> control field must
1042 be present and must contain at least one human with their
1043 personal email address. See <ref id="f-Uploaders"> for the
1044 syntax of that field.
1048 An orphaned package is one with no current maintainer. Orphaned
1049 packages should have their <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field set
1050 to <tt>Debian QA Group <packages@qa.debian.org></tt>.
1051 These packages are considered maintained by the Debian project
1052 as a whole until someone else volunteers to take over
1053 maintenance.<footnote>
1054 The detailed procedure for gracefully orphaning a package can
1055 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference
1056 (see <ref id="related">).
1061 <sect id="descriptions">
1062 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
1065 Every Debian package must have a <tt>Description</tt> control
1066 field which contains a synopsis and extended description of the
1067 package. Technical information about the format of the
1068 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
1072 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
1073 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
1074 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
1075 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
1076 from the program's documentation.
1080 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
1081 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
1082 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
1083 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
1084 extended description.
1088 The description should also give information about the
1089 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
1090 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
1091 conflicts have been declared.
1095 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
1096 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
1097 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
1098 statements and other administrivia should not be included
1099 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
1102 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
1105 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
1106 under 80 characters.
1110 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
1111 display software knows how to display this already, and you
1112 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
1113 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
1114 informative as you can.
1119 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
1122 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
1123 extended description. This will not work correctly when
1124 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
1125 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
1130 The extended description should describe what the package
1131 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
1132 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
1136 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
1137 people who have no idea about any of the things the
1138 package deals with.<footnote>
1139 The blurb that comes with a program in its
1140 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
1141 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
1142 usually aimed at people who are already in the
1143 community where the package is used.
1151 <sect id="dependencies">
1152 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1155 Every package must specify the dependency information
1156 about other packages that are required for the first to
1161 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1162 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1163 binary in a package.
1167 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1168 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1169 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1170 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1172 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1173 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1174 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1175 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1176 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1177 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1178 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1179 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1183 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1184 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1185 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1186 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1187 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1194 Sometimes, unpacking one package requires that another package
1195 be first unpacked <em>and</em> configured. In this case, the
1196 depending package must specify this dependency in
1197 the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> control field.
1201 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1202 package before this has been discussed on the
1203 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1204 doing that has been reached.
1208 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1209 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1213 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1214 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1217 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1218 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1219 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1220 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1221 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1222 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1223 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1224 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1225 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1226 specify all possible packages individually.
1230 All packages should use virtual package names where
1231 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1232 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1233 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1234 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1235 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1239 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1240 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1241 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1242 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1243 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1247 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1254 <heading>Base system</heading>
1257 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1258 system that is installed before everything else
1259 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1260 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1265 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1266 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1267 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1272 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1275 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1276 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1277 when packages are in the "Unpacked" state.
1278 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1279 <tt>Essential</tt> control field. The format of the
1280 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1285 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1286 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1287 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1288 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1289 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1290 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1291 remove it when it has been superseded.
1295 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1296 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1297 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1298 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1299 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1300 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1301 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1306 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1307 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1308 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1309 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1310 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1311 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1312 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1313 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1314 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1319 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1320 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1321 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1326 <sect id="maintscripts">
1327 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1330 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1331 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1332 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1333 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1334 amongst other things, not passing the <tt>--verbose</tt>
1335 option to <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
1339 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1340 script must be checked and the installation must not
1341 continue after an error.
1345 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1346 maintainer scripts, too.
1350 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file belonging
1351 to another package without consulting the maintainer of that
1352 package first. When adding or removing diversions, package
1353 maintainer scripts must provide the <tt>--package</tt> flag
1354 to <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> and must not use <tt>--local</tt>.
1358 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1359 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1360 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1361 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1362 is not used, then each package must use
1363 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1364 removed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1365 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1366 that previously did not use
1367 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1368 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1372 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1373 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1375 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1376 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1377 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1378 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1379 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1383 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1384 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1385 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1389 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1390 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1391 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1392 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1393 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1394 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1398 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1399 Specification may contain the additional control information
1400 files <file>config</file>
1401 and <file>templates</file>. <file>config</file> is an
1402 additional maintainer script used for package configuration,
1403 and <file>templates</file> contains templates used for user
1404 prompting. The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before
1405 the <prgn>preinst</prgn> script and before the package is
1406 unpacked or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are
1407 satisfied. Therefore it must work using only the tools
1408 present in <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1409 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1410 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1411 Specification will also be installed, and any
1412 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1413 before preconfiguration begins.
1418 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1419 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1420 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1421 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1425 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1426 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1427 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1428 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1429 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1430 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1431 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1432 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1437 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1438 questions again, unless the user has used
1439 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1440 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1441 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1442 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1447 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1448 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1449 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1450 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1451 messages"), it should display this in the
1452 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1453 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1454 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1455 important (they belong in
1456 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1457 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1458 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1463 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1464 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1465 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1466 should be protected with a conditional so that
1467 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1468 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1469 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1470 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1480 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1482 <sect id="standardsversion">
1483 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1486 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1487 of this policy document with which your package complied
1488 when it was last updated.
1492 This information may be used to file bug reports
1493 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1497 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1499 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1500 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1504 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1505 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1506 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1507 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1508 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1509 release it.<footnote>
1510 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1511 information about policy which has changed between
1512 different versions of this document.
1518 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1519 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1522 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1523 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1524 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1525 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1526 specified as a build-time dependency.
1530 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1531 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1532 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1533 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1534 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1535 an informational list can be found in
1536 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1537 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1540 <list compact="compact">
1542 This allows maintaining the list separately
1543 from the policy documents (the list does not
1544 need the kind of control that the policy
1548 Having a separate package allows one to install
1549 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1550 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1551 require installation of the build-essential
1552 packages using the depends relation.
1555 The separate package allows bug reports against
1556 the list to be categorized separately from
1557 the policy management process in the BTS.
1564 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1565 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1566 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1567 required merely because some other package in the list of
1568 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1569 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1570 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1571 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1572 others need is their business. For example, if you
1573 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1574 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1575 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1576 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1577 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1578 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1579 dependencies are satisfied.
1584 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1585 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1586 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1587 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1588 build-time relationships (including any implied
1589 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1590 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1591 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1592 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1593 are properly satisfied.
1597 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1602 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1605 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1606 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1607 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1608 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1613 If you need to configure the package differently for
1614 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1615 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1616 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1617 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1618 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1619 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1620 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1624 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1625 detects the correct architecture specification string
1626 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1630 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1631 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1632 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1633 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1634 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1635 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1636 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1637 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1643 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1644 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1647 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1648 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1649 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1651 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1652 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1653 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1656 This includes modifications
1657 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1658 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1660 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1661 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1662 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1663 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1664 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1665 as a non-native package.
1670 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1671 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1672 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1676 That format is a series of entries like this:
1678 <example compact="compact">
1679 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1681 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1683 * <var>change details</var>
1684 <var>more change details</var>
1686 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1688 * <var>even more change details</var>
1690 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1692 -- <var>maintainer name</var> <<var>email address</var>><var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1697 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1698 package name and version number.
1702 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1703 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1704 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1705 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1709 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1710 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1711 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1712 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1713 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1714 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1715 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1720 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1721 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1722 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1723 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1724 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1725 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1729 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1730 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1731 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1732 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1733 in the change details.<footnote>
1734 To be precise, the string should match the following
1735 Perl regular expression:
1737 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1739 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1740 archive maintenance software (<prgn>dak</prgn>) using the
1741 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1743 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1744 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1748 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1749 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1750 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1751 usual package maintainer.<footnote>
1752 If the developer uploading the package is not one of the usual
1753 maintainers of the package (as listed in
1754 the <qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref>
1755 or <qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref> control
1756 fields of the package), the first line of the changelog is
1757 conventionally used to explain why a non-maintainer is
1758 uploading the package. The Debian Developer's Reference
1759 (see <ref id="related">) documents the conventions
1761 The information here will be copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt>
1762 field in the <tt>.changes</tt> file
1763 (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">), and then later used to send an
1764 acknowledgement when the upload has been installed.
1768 The <var>date</var> has the following format<footnote>
1769 This is the same as the format generated by <tt>date
1771 </footnote> (compatible and with the same semantics of
1772 RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
1773 <example>day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz</example>
1775 <list compact="compact">
1777 day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
1780 dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
1783 month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug,
1786 <item>yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)</item>
1787 <item>hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)</item>
1788 <item>mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)</item>
1789 <item>ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)</item>
1791 +zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated
1792 Universal Time (UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead
1793 of (i.e., east of) UTC and "-" indicates that the time is
1794 behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The first two digits indicate
1795 the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
1796 indicate the number of additional minutes difference from
1797 UTC. The last two digits must be in the range 00-59.
1803 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1804 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1805 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1806 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1807 separated by exactly two spaces.
1811 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1815 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1816 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1820 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1821 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1823 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
1824 copyright information and distribution license in the file
1825 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1826 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1827 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations related
1828 to copyrights for packages.
1832 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1835 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1836 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1837 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1838 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1839 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1840 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1841 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1842 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1847 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1848 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1849 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1850 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1851 then running a program, using <tt>&&</tt> rather
1852 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1853 more complex commands including most loops and
1854 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1855 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1856 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1860 <sect id="timestamps">
1861 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1863 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1864 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1866 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1867 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1868 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1869 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1870 modification time of the upstream source would be
1876 <sect id="restrictions">
1877 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1880 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1882 This is not currently detected when building source
1883 packages, but only when extracting
1887 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1888 future, but would require a fair amount of
1891 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1892 setgid files.<footnote>
1893 Setgid directories are allowed.
1898 <sect id="debianrules">
1899 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1902 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1903 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1904 building binary package(s) from the source.
1908 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1909 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1910 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly. That is, invoking
1911 either of <tt>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt>
1912 or <tt>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt> must result in
1917 The following targets are required and must be implemented
1918 by <file>debian/rules</file>: <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
1919 <tt>binary-arch</tt>, <tt>binary-indep</tt>, <tt>build</tt>,
1920 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1921 These are the targets called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
1925 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1926 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it hard
1927 for other people to reproduce the same binary package, all
1928 required targets must be non-interactive. It also follows that
1929 any target that these targets depend on must also be
1934 The targets are as follows:
1936 <tag><tt>build</tt> (required)</tag>
1939 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1940 configuration and compilation of the package.
1941 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1942 configuration routine, the Debian source package
1943 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1944 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1945 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1946 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1947 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1948 detected by the configuration routine.)
1952 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1953 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1954 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1955 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1956 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1957 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1958 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1959 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1960 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1961 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1962 binary package out of each.
1966 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1967 that might require root privilege.
1971 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1972 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1976 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1977 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1978 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1979 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1980 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1981 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1982 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1984 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1985 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1986 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1987 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1988 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1989 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1990 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1991 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1992 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1993 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1994 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
2000 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (required),
2001 <tt>build-indep</tt> (required)
2005 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target must
2006 perform all the configuration and compilation required for
2007 producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
2008 (those packages for which the body of the
2009 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt> is
2010 not <tt>all</tt>). Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt>
2011 target must perform all the configuration
2012 and compilation required for producing all
2013 architecture-independent binary packages (those packages
2014 for which the body of the <tt>Architecture</tt> field
2015 in <tt>debian/control</tt> is <tt>all</tt>).
2016 The <tt>build</tt> target
2017 should either depend on those targets or take the same
2018 actions as invoking those targets would perform.<footnote>
2019 This split allows binary-only builds to not install the
2020 dependencies required for the <tt>build-indep</tt>
2021 target and skip any resource-intensive build tasks that
2022 are only required when building architecture-independent
2028 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
2029 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
2033 <tag><tt>binary</tt> (required), <tt>binary-arch</tt>
2034 (required), <tt>binary-indep</tt> (required)
2038 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
2039 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
2040 produced from this source package. It is
2041 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
2042 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
2043 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
2044 those which are not.
2047 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
2048 no commands which simply depends on
2049 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
2052 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
2053 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
2054 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
2055 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
2056 been already. It should then create the relevant
2057 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2058 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
2059 build them and place them in the parent of the top
2064 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
2065 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
2066 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
2067 the case if the source generates only a single binary
2068 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
2069 must still exist and must always succeed.
2073 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
2075 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
2076 to build a package correctly even without being
2082 <tag><tt>clean</tt> (required)</tag>
2085 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
2086 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
2087 that it should leave alone any output files created in
2088 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
2093 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
2094 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
2095 should be removed as the first action that
2096 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
2097 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
2098 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
2103 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
2104 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
2105 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
2106 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
2107 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
2112 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
2115 This target fetches the most recent version of the
2116 original source package from a canonical archive site
2117 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
2118 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
2119 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
2124 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
2125 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
2130 This target is optional, but providing it if
2131 possible is a good idea.
2135 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
2138 This target performs whatever additional actions are
2139 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
2140 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
2141 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
2142 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
2143 for additional modification. See
2144 <ref id="readmesource">.
2150 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
2151 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
2152 directory being the package's top-level directory.
2157 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
2158 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
2159 package's internal use.
2163 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
2164 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the
2165 utility <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn>.
2166 You can determine the Debian architecture and the GNU style
2167 architecture specification string for the build architecture as
2168 well as for the host architecture. The build architecture is
2169 the architecture on which <file>debian/rules</file> is run and
2170 the package build is performed. The host architecture is the
2171 architecture on which the resulting package will be installed
2172 and run. These are normally the same, but may be different in
2173 the case of cross-compilation (building packages for one
2174 architecture on machines of a different architecture).
2178 Here is a list of supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
2179 <list compact="compact">
2181 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
2184 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
2187 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2190 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2191 specification string)
2194 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2195 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2198 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2199 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2201 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2202 the build architecture or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2207 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2208 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2209 values; please refer to the documentation of
2210 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2214 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2215 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2216 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2217 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2218 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2219 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2223 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2224 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2225 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2228 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2229 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2230 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2231 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2232 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2233 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2234 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2235 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2236 flag values that contain commas.
2238 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2239 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2240 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2241 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2242 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2243 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2244 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2245 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2249 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2253 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2254 provided by the package.
2258 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2259 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2260 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2261 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2262 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2263 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2264 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2268 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2269 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2270 debugging information may be included in the package.
2272 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2274 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2275 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2276 system supports this.<footnote>
2277 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2278 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2281 If the package build system does not support parallel
2282 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2283 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2284 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2285 many parallel processes as the package build system
2286 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2287 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2288 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2289 parallel builds worthwhile.
2295 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2299 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2300 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2301 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2303 <example compact="compact">
2306 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2307 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2308 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2309 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2311 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2316 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2317 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2319 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2320 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2321 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2326 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2327 # Code to run the package test suite.
2334 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2335 <sect id="substvars">
2336 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2339 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>
2340 generates <qref id="binarycontrolfiles">binary package control
2341 files</qref> (<file>DEBIAN/control</file>), it performs variable
2342 substitutions on its output just before writing it. Variable
2343 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2344 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2345 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2346 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2347 option to the source packaging commands, and certain predefined
2348 variables are also available.
2352 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2353 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2354 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2358 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2359 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2360 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2363 <sect id="debianwatch">
2364 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2367 This is an optional, recommended configuration file for the
2368 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically scan
2369 ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2370 package. This is used Debian QA
2371 tools to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2372 distribution as a whole.
2377 <sect id="debianfiles">
2378 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2381 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2382 is used while building packages to record which files are
2383 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2384 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2388 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2389 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2390 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2391 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2392 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2393 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2394 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2395 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2397 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2398 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2399 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2400 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2404 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2405 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2406 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2407 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2408 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2409 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2413 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2414 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2415 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2416 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2417 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2418 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2421 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2422 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2425 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2426 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2427 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2428 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2429 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2430 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2431 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2433 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2434 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2435 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2436 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2437 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2438 prerequisite if possible.
2440 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2441 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2442 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2443 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2449 <sect id="readmesource">
2450 <heading>Source package handling:
2451 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2454 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2455 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2456 and allow one to make changes and run
2457 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2458 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2459 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2460 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2463 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2464 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2465 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2466 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2467 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2468 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2469 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2470 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2471 applied when building the package.</item>
2472 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2473 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2474 if applicable.</item>
2476 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2477 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2478 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2483 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2484 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2485 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2486 a general reference manual.
2490 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2491 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2492 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2493 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2494 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2495 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2496 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2497 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2503 <chapt id="controlfields">
2504 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2507 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2508 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2509 <em>control files</em>.
2510 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2511 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2512 of uploaded files<footnote>
2513 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2518 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2519 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2522 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2524 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2526 The paragraphs are separated by empty lines. Parsers may accept
2527 lines consisting solely of spaces and tabs as paragraph
2528 separators, but control files should use empty lines. Some control
2529 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2530 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2531 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2532 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2533 refer to binary packages generated from the source.) The
2534 ordering of the paragraphs in control files is significant.
2538 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields. Each field
2539 consists of the field name followed by a colon and then the
2540 data/value associated with that field. The field name is
2541 composed of US-ASCII characters excluding control characters,
2542 space, and colon (i.e., characters in the ranges 33-57 and
2543 59-126, inclusive). Field names must not begin with the comment
2544 character, <tt>#</tt>, nor with the hyphen character, <tt>-</tt>.
2548 The field ends at the end of the line or at the end of the last
2549 continuation line (see below). Horizontal whitespace (spaces
2550 and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the value and is
2551 ignored there; it is conventional to put a single space after
2552 the colon. For example, a field might be:
2553 <example compact="compact">
2556 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2561 A paragraph must not contain more than one instance of a
2562 particular field name.
2566 There are three types of fields:
2570 The field, including its value, must be a single line. Folding
2571 of the field is not permitted. This is the default field type
2572 if the definition of the field does not specify a different
2577 The value of a folded field is a logical line that may span
2578 several lines. The lines after the first are called
2579 continuation lines and must start with a space or a tab.
2580 Whitespace, including any newlines, is not significant in the
2581 field values of folded fields.<footnote>
2582 This folding method is similar to RFC 5322, allowing control
2583 files that contain only one paragraph and no multiline fields
2584 to be read by parsers written for RFC 5322.
2587 <tag>multiline</tag>
2589 The value of a multiline field may comprise multiple continuation
2590 lines. The first line of the value, the part on the same line as
2591 the field name, often has special significance or may have to be
2592 empty. Other lines are added following the same syntax as the
2593 continuation lines of the folded fields. Whitespace, including newlines,
2594 is significant in the values of multiline fields.
2600 Whitespace must not appear
2601 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2602 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2603 multi-character version relationships.
2607 The presence and purpose of a field, and the syntax of its
2608 value may differ between types of control files.
2612 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2613 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2614 Field values are case-sensitive unless the description of the
2615 field says otherwise.
2619 Paragraph separators (empty lines) and lines consisting only of
2620 spaces and tabs are not allowed within field values or between
2621 fields. Empty lines in field values are usually escaped by
2622 representing them by a space followed by a dot.
2626 Lines starting with # without any preceding whitespace are comments
2627 lines that are only permitted in source package control files
2628 (<file>debian/control</file>). These comment lines are ignored, even
2629 between two continuation lines. They do not end logical lines.
2633 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2637 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2638 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2641 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2642 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2643 and about the binary packages it creates.
2647 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2648 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2649 binary package that the source tree builds.
2653 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2656 <list compact="compact">
2657 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2658 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2659 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2660 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2661 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2662 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2663 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2664 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2665 <item><qref id="f-VCS-fields"><tt>Vcs-Browser</tt>, <tt>Vcs-Git</tt>, et al.</qref></item>
2670 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2672 <list compact="compact">
2673 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2674 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2675 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2676 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2677 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2678 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2679 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2680 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2681 <item><qref id="built-using"><tt>Built-Using</tt></qref></item>
2682 <item><qref id="f-Package-Type"><tt>Package-Type</tt></qref></item>
2687 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2691 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2692 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2693 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2694 <file>.changes</file> file to accompany the upload, and by
2695 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2696 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2697 archive. Some fields are folded in <file>debian/control</file>,
2698 but not in any other control
2699 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2700 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2701 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2705 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2706 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2707 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2708 when they generate output control files.
2709 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2713 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2714 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2717 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2718 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package. It
2719 consists of a single paragraph.
2723 The fields in this file are:
2725 <list compact="compact">
2726 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2727 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2728 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2729 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2730 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2731 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2732 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2733 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2734 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2735 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2736 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2737 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2738 <item><qref id="built-using"><tt>Built-Using</tt></qref></item>
2743 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2744 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2747 This file consists of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by
2748 a PGP signature. The fields of that paragraph are listed below.
2749 Their syntax is described above, in <ref id="controlsyntax">.
2751 <list compact="compact">
2752 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2753 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2754 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2755 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2756 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2757 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2758 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2759 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2760 <item><qref id="f-VCS-fields"><tt>Vcs-Browser</tt>, <tt>Vcs-Git</tt>, et al.</qref></item>
2761 <item><qref id="f-Dgit"><tt>Dgit</tt></qref></item>
2762 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2763 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2764 <item><qref id="f-Package-List"><tt>Package-List</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2765 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2766 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2767 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2772 The Debian source control file is generated by
2773 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2774 archive, from other files in the source package,
2775 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2776 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2782 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2783 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2786 The <file>.changes</file> files are used by the Debian archive
2787 maintenance software to process updates to packages. They
2788 consist of a single paragraph, possibly surrounded by a PGP
2789 signature. That paragraph contains information from the
2790 <file>debian/control</file> file and other data about the
2791 source package gathered via <file>debian/changelog</file>
2792 and <file>debian/rules</file>.
2796 <file>.changes</file> files have a format version that is
2797 incremented whenever the documented fields or their meaning
2798 change. This document describes format &changesversion;.
2802 The fields in this file are:
2804 <list compact="compact">
2805 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2806 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2807 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2808 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2809 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2810 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2811 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2812 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2813 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2814 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2815 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2816 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2817 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2818 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2819 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2820 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2825 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2826 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2828 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2829 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2832 This field identifies the source package name.
2836 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2837 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2841 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2842 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2843 number in parentheses<footnote>
2844 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2845 if a version number is specified.
2847 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2848 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2849 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2850 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2851 package control file when the source package has the same
2852 name and version as the binary package.
2856 Package names (both source and binary,
2857 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2858 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2859 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2860 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2861 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2865 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2866 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2869 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2870 must come first, then the email address inside angle
2871 brackets <tt><></tt> (in RFC822 format).
2875 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2876 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2877 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2878 program using this field as an address must check for this
2879 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2880 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2881 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2885 See <ref id="maintainer"> for additional requirements and
2886 information about package maintainers.
2890 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2891 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2894 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of the
2895 package, if any. If the package has other maintainers besides
2896 the one named in the <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer
2897 field</qref>, their names and email addresses should be listed
2898 here. The format of each entry is the same as that of the
2899 Maintainer field, and multiple entries must be comma
2904 This is normally an optional field, but if
2905 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field names a group of people
2906 and a shared email address, the <tt>Uploaders</tt> field must
2907 be present and must contain at least one human with their
2908 personal email address.
2912 The Uploaders field in <file>debian/control</file> can be folded.
2916 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2917 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2920 The name and email address of the person who prepared this
2921 version of the package, usually a maintainer. The syntax is
2922 the same as for the <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer
2927 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2928 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2931 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2932 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2936 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2937 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2938 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2939 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2944 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2945 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2948 This field represents how important it is that the user
2949 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2953 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2954 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2955 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2956 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2961 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2962 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2965 The name of the binary package.
2969 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2970 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2975 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2976 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2979 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2980 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2984 A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2985 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2988 An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian
2989 machine architectures, see <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">.
2990 <tt>any</tt> matches all Debian machine architectures
2991 and is the most frequently used.
2994 <tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2995 architecture-independent package.
2998 <tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
3004 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
3005 package, this field may contain the special
3006 value <tt>all</tt>, the special architecture
3007 wildcard <tt>any</tt>, or a list of specific and wildcard
3008 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>all</tt>
3009 or <tt>any</tt> appears, that value must be the entire
3010 contents of the field. Most packages will use
3011 either <tt>all</tt> or <tt>any</tt>.
3015 Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the
3016 source will build an architecture-dependent package only on
3017 architectures included in the list. Specifying a list of
3018 architecture wildcards indicates that the source will build an
3019 architecture-dependent package on only those architectures
3020 that match any of the specified architecture wildcards.
3021 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
3022 other than <tt>any</tt> is for the minority of cases where a
3023 program is not portable or is not useful on some
3024 architectures. Where possible, the program should be made
3029 In the Debian source control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
3030 field contains a list of architectures and architecture
3031 wildcards separated by spaces. When the list contains the
3032 architecture wildcard <tt>any</tt>, the only other value
3033 allowed in the list is <tt>all</tt>.
3037 The list may include (or consist solely of) the special
3038 value <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file>
3039 files unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may
3040 occur in combination with specific architectures.
3041 The <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the Debian source control
3042 file <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from
3043 the <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in
3044 the <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
3048 Specifying only <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
3049 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
3050 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
3051 will be specific to whatever the current build architecture is.
3055 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
3056 will only build architecture-independent packages.
3060 Specifying <tt>any all</tt> indicates that the source package
3061 isn't dependent on any particular architecture. The set of
3062 produced binary packages will include at least one
3063 architecture-dependant package and one architecture-independent
3068 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
3069 indicates that the source will build an architecture-dependent
3070 package, and will only work correctly on the listed or
3071 matching architectures. If the source package also builds at
3072 least one architecture-independent package, <tt>all</tt> will
3073 also be included in the list.
3077 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
3078 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s) currently
3079 being uploaded. This will be a list; if the source for the
3080 package is also being uploaded, the special
3081 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
3082 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
3083 uploaded. Architecture wildcards such as <tt>any</tt> must
3084 never occur in the <tt>Architecture</tt> field in
3085 the <file>.changes</file> file.
3089 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information on how to get
3090 the architecture for the build process.
3094 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
3095 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
3098 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
3099 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
3100 paragraph of a source package control file.
3104 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
3105 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
3106 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
3107 which is the same as not having the field at all.
3112 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
3113 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
3114 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
3115 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
3116 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
3120 These fields describe the package's relationships with
3121 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
3122 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
3125 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
3126 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
3129 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
3130 manual and associated texts) with which the package
3135 The version number has four components: major and minor
3136 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
3137 standards change in a way that requires every package to
3138 change the major number will be changed. Significant
3139 changes that will require work in many packages will be
3140 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
3141 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
3142 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
3143 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
3144 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
3145 nor affect the contents of packages.
3149 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
3150 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
3151 field, and so either these three components or all four
3152 components may be specified.<footnote>
3153 In the past, people specified the full version number
3154 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
3155 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
3156 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
3157 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
3158 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
3159 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
3165 <sect1 id="f-Version">
3166 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
3169 The version number of a package. The format is:
3170 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
3174 The three components here are:
3176 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
3179 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
3180 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
3181 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
3186 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
3187 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
3188 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
3192 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
3195 This is the main part of the version number. It is
3196 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
3197 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
3198 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
3199 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
3200 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
3201 package management system's format and comparison
3206 The comparison behavior of the package management system
3207 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
3208 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
3209 portion of the version number is mandatory.
3213 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
3214 alphanumerics<footnote>
3215 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
3217 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
3218 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
3219 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
3220 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
3221 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
3226 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
3229 This part of the version number specifies the version of
3230 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
3231 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
3232 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
3233 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
3234 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
3238 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
3239 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
3240 This format represents the case where a piece of
3241 software was written specifically to be a Debian
3242 package, where the Debian package source must always
3243 be identical to the pristine source and therefore no
3244 revision indication is required.
3248 It is conventional to restart the
3249 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
3250 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
3254 The package management system will break the version
3255 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
3256 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
3257 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
3258 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
3259 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
3266 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
3267 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
3268 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
3269 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
3270 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
3271 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
3272 parts are compared by the package management system using the
3273 following algorithm:
3277 The strings are compared from left to right.
3281 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
3282 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
3283 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
3284 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
3285 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
3286 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
3287 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
3288 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3289 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3290 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3291 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3292 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3293 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3298 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3299 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3300 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3301 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3302 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3303 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3308 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3309 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3310 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3314 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3315 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3316 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3317 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3318 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3319 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3320 silly orderings.<footnote>
3321 The author of this manual has heard of a package whose
3322 versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>, <tt>1.3</tt>,
3323 <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>, <tt>2</tt> and so
3329 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3330 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3333 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3334 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3335 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3336 long description. It is a multiline field with the following
3342 Description: <single line synopsis>
3343 <extended description over several lines>
3348 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3354 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3355 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3356 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3357 The line must contain at least one non-whitespace character.
3361 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3362 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3363 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3364 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3365 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3366 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3367 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3368 indenting work correctly, for example). The line must
3369 contain at least one non-whitespace character.
3373 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3374 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3375 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3376 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3377 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3378 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3379 likely abort with an error.
3384 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3385 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3391 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3395 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3399 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3400 field contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages
3401 being uploaded. For this case, the first line of the field
3402 value (the part on the same line as <tt>Description:</tt>) is
3403 always empty. It is a multiline field, with one
3404 line per package. Each line is
3405 indented by one space and contains the name of a binary
3406 package, a space, a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>), a space, and the
3407 short description line from that package.
3411 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3412 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3415 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3416 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3417 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3418 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3419 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3420 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3421 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3422 <taglist compact="compact">
3423 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3425 This distribution value refers to the
3426 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3427 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3428 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3432 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3434 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3435 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3436 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3437 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3438 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3439 of the Debian distribution tree.
3444 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3445 security uploads. More information is available in the
3446 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3450 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3451 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3452 handled outside of the upload process.
3457 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3460 This field includes the date the package was built or last
3461 edited. It must be in the same format as the <var>date</var>
3462 in a <file>debian/changelog</file> entry.
3466 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3467 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3468 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3472 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3473 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3476 In <qref id="debianchangesfiles"><file>.changes</file></qref>
3477 files, this field declares the format version of that file.
3478 The syntax of the field value is the same as that of
3479 a <qref id="f-Version">package version number</qref> except
3480 that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed. The format
3481 described in this document is <tt>&changesversion;</tt>.
3485 In <qref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles"><file>.dsc</file>
3486 Debian source control</qref> files, this field declares the
3487 format of the source package. The field value is used by
3488 programs acting on a source package to interpret the list of
3489 files in the source package and determine how to unpack it.
3490 The syntax of the field value is a numeric major revision, a
3491 period, a numeric minor revision, and then an optional subtype
3492 after whitespace, which if specified is an alphanumeric word
3493 in parentheses. The subtype is optional in the syntax but may
3494 be mandatory for particular source format revisions.
3496 The source formats currently supported by the Debian archive
3497 software are <tt>1.0</tt>, <tt>3.0 (native)</tt>,
3498 and <tt>3.0 (quilt)</tt>.
3503 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3504 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3507 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3508 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3509 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3510 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3511 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3512 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3513 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3514 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3515 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3516 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3517 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3518 treated as synonymous.
3519 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3520 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3521 parentheses. For example:
3524 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3530 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3531 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3532 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3536 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3537 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3540 This multiline field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3541 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3545 The first line of the field value (the part on the same line
3546 as <tt>Changes:</tt>) is always empty. The content of the
3547 field is expressed as continuation lines, with each line
3548 indented by at least one space. Blank lines must be
3549 represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full
3554 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3555 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3556 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3560 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3561 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3562 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3566 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3567 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3568 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3569 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3570 representation of a blank line).
3574 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3575 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3578 This folded field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and
3579 meaning varies depending on the control file in which it
3584 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file, it lists binary
3585 packages which a source package can produce, separated by
3587 A space after each comma is conventional.
3588 </footnote>. The source package
3589 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages for
3590 every architecture. The source control file doesn't contain
3591 details of which architectures are appropriate for which of
3592 the binary packages.
3596 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file, it lists the
3597 names of the binary packages being uploaded, separated by
3598 whitespace (not commas).
3602 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3603 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3606 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3607 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3608 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3609 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3610 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3615 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3616 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3620 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3621 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3624 This field contains a list of files with information about
3625 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3630 In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of
3631 the field value (the part on the same line as <tt>Files:</tt>)
3632 is always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3633 continuation lines, one line per file. Each line must be
3634 indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
3635 separated by spaces, as described below.
3639 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3640 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if
3641 applicable) diff file which make up the remainder of the
3642 source package<footnote>
3643 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3644 </footnote>. For example:
3647 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3648 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3650 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3651 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3655 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3656 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3657 size, section and priority and the filename. For example:
3660 4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
3661 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3662 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3663 7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
3665 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3666 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref> are the values of
3667 the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
3668 no section or priority is specified then <tt>-</tt> should be
3669 used, though section and priority values must be specified for
3670 new packages to be installed properly.
3674 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3675 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3676 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3677 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3678 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3682 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3683 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3684 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3685 entry for the original source archive
3686 <file><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3687 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3688 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3689 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3690 source archive which was used to generate the
3691 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3694 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3695 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3698 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3699 governed by the .changes file closes.
3703 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3704 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3707 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3708 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3709 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3710 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3711 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3716 <sect1 id="f-Checksums">
3717 <heading><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3718 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></heading>
3721 These multiline fields contain a list of files with a checksum and size
3722 for each one. Both <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3723 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> have the same syntax and differ
3724 only in the checksum algorithm used: SHA-1
3725 for <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and SHA-256
3726 for <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt>.
3730 <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> are
3731 multiline fields. The first line of the field value (the part
3732 on the same line as <tt>Checksums-Sha1:</tt>
3733 or <tt>Checksums-Sha256:</tt>) is always empty. The content
3734 of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line per
3735 file. Each line consists of the checksum, a space, the file
3736 size, a space, and the file name. For example (from
3737 a <file>.changes</file> file):
3740 1f418afaa01464e63cc1ee8a66a05f0848bd155c 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3741 a0ed1456fad61116f868b1855530dbe948e20f06 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3742 5e86ecf0671e113b63388dac81dd8d00e00ef298 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3743 71a0ff7da0faaf608481195f9cf30974b142c183 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3745 ac9d57254f7e835bed299926fd51bf6f534597cc3fcc52db01c4bffedae81272 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3746 0d123be7f51e61c4bf15e5c492b484054be7e90f3081608a5517007bfb1fd128 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3747 f54ae966a5f580571ae7d9ef5e1df0bd42d63e27cb505b27957351a495bc6288 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3748 3bec05c03974fdecd11d020fc2e8250de8404867a8a2ce865160c250eb723664 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3753 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, these fields list all
3754 files that make up the source package. In
3755 the <file>.changes</file> file, these fields list all
3756 files being uploaded. The list of files in these fields
3757 must match the list of files in the <tt>Files</tt> field.
3762 <heading><tt>DM-Upload-Allowed</tt></heading>
3765 Obsolete, see <qref id="f-DM-Upload-Allowed">below</qref>.
3769 <sect1 id="f-VCS-fields">
3770 <heading>Version Control System (VCS) fields</heading>
3773 Debian source packages are increasingly developed using VCSs. The
3774 purpose of the following fields is to indicate a publicly accessible
3775 repository where the Debian source package is developed.
3778 <tag><tt>Vcs-Browser</tt></tag>
3781 URL of a web interface for browsing the repository.
3786 <tt>Vcs-Arch</tt>, <tt>Vcs-Bzr</tt> (Bazaar), <tt>Vcs-Cvs</tt>,
3787 <tt>Vcs-Darcs</tt>, <tt>Vcs-Git</tt>, <tt>Vcs-Hg</tt>
3788 (Mercurial), <tt>Vcs-Mtn</tt> (Monotone), <tt>Vcs-Svn</tt>
3793 The field name identifies the VCS. The field's value uses the
3794 version control system's conventional syntax for describing
3795 repository locations and should be sufficient to locate the
3796 repository used for packaging. Ideally, it also locates the
3797 branch used for development of new versions of the Debian
3801 In the case of Git, the value consists of a URL, optionally
3802 followed by the word <tt>-b</tt> and the name of a branch in
3803 the indicated repository, following the syntax of the
3804 <tt>git clone</tt> command. If no branch is specified, the
3805 packaging should be on the default branch.
3808 More than one different VCS may be specified for the same
3816 <sect1 id="f-Package-List">
3817 <heading><tt>Package-List</tt></heading>
3820 Multiline field listing all the packages that can be built from
3821 the source package, considering every architecture. The first line
3822 of the field value is empty. Each one of the next lines describes
3823 one binary package, by listing its name, type, section and priority
3824 separated by spaces. Fifth and subsequent space-separated items
3825 may be present and parsers must allow them. See the
3826 <qref id="f-Package-Type">Package-Type</qref> field for a list of
3831 <sect1 id="f-Package-Type">
3832 <heading><tt>Package-Type</tt></heading>
3835 Simple field containing a word indicating the type of package:
3836 <tt>deb</tt> for binary packages and <tt>udeb</tt> for micro binary
3837 packages. Other types not defined here may be indicated. In
3838 source package control files, the <tt>Package-Type</tt> field
3839 should be omitted instead of giving it a value of <tt>deb</tt>, as
3840 this value is assumed for paragraphs lacking this field.
3845 <heading><tt>Dgit</tt></heading>
3848 Folded field containing a single git commit hash, presented in
3849 full, followed optionally by whitespace and other data to be
3850 defined in future extensions.
3854 Declares that the source package corresponds exactly to a
3855 referenced commit in a Git repository available at the canonical
3856 location called <em>dgit-repos</em>, used by <prgn>dgit</prgn>, a
3857 bidirectional gateway between the Debian archive and Git. The
3858 commit is reachable from at least one reference whose name matches
3859 <tt>refs/dgit/*</tt>. See the manual page of <prgn>dgit</prgn> for
3866 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3869 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3870 source package control file. Such fields will be
3871 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3872 Debian source control files or upload control files.
3876 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3877 these output files you should use the mechanism
3882 Fields in the main source control information file with
3883 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3884 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3885 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3886 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3887 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3888 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3889 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in Debian source control
3890 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3891 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3895 For example, if the main source information control file
3898 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3900 then the binary and Debian source control files will contain the
3903 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3909 <sect id="obsolete-control-data-fields">
3910 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
3913 The following fields have been obsoleted and may be found in packages
3914 conforming with previous versions of the Policy.
3917 <sect1 id="f-DM-Upload-Allowed">
3918 <heading><tt>DM-Upload-Allowed</tt></heading>
3921 Indicates that Debian Maintainers may upload this package to
3922 the Debian archive. The only valid value is <tt>yes</tt>. This
3923 field was used to regulate uploads by Debian Maintainers, See the
3924 General Resolution <url id="http://www.debian.org/vote/2007/vote_003"
3925 name="Endorse the concept of Debian Maintainers"> for more details.
3934 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3935 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3938 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3941 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3942 the package management system will run for you when your
3943 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3947 These scripts are the control information
3948 files <prgn>preinst</prgn>, <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3949 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>. They must be proper executable files;
3950 if they are scripts (which is recommended), they must start with
3951 the usual <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3952 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3956 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3957 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3958 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3959 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3960 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3961 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3962 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3963 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3967 Additionally, packages interacting with users
3968 using <prgn>debconf</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
3969 should install a <prgn>config</prgn> script as a control
3970 information file. See <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3974 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3975 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3976 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3977 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3978 check the arguments to your scripts.
3982 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3983 (a particular version of) a package is unpacked, and the
3984 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3985 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3986 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3990 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3991 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3992 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3993 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>,
3994 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3995 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3996 other program that one would expect to be in the
3997 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3998 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3999 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
4000 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
4001 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
4004 <sect id="idempotency">
4005 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
4008 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
4009 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
4010 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
4011 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
4012 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
4013 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
4014 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
4015 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
4017 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
4018 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
4019 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
4020 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
4026 <sect id="controllingterminal">
4027 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
4030 Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling
4031 terminal and may not be able to interact with the user. They
4032 must be able to fall back to noninteractive behavior if no
4033 controlling terminal is available. Maintainer scripts that
4034 prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
4035 Management Specification (see <ref id="maintscriptprompt">) may
4036 assume that program will handle falling back to noninteractive
4041 For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer,
4042 maintainer scripts may abort if there is no controlling
4043 terminal. However, this situation should be avoided if at all
4044 possible, since it prevents automated or unattended installs.
4045 In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the
4050 <sect id="exitstatus">
4051 <heading>Exit status</heading>
4054 Each script must return a zero exit status for
4055 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
4056 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
4057 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
4061 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
4066 What follows is a summary of all the ways in which maintainer
4067 scripts may be called along with what facilities those scripts
4068 may rely on being available at that time. Script names preceded
4069 by <var>new-</var> are the scripts from the new version of a
4070 package being installed, upgraded to, or downgraded to. Script
4071 names preceded by <var>old-</var> are the scripts from the old
4072 version of a package that is being upgraded from or downgraded
4077 The <prgn>preinst</prgn> script may be called in the following
4080 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt></tag>
4081 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
4082 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4083 <tag><var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
4084 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4086 The package will not yet be unpacked, so
4087 the <prgn>preinst</prgn> script cannot rely on any files
4088 included in its package. Only essential packages and
4089 pre-dependencies (<tt>Pre-Depends</tt>) may be assumed to be
4090 available. Pre-dependencies will have been configured at
4091 least once, but at the time the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is
4092 called they may only be in an "Unpacked" or "Half-Configured"
4093 state if a previous version of the pre-dependency was
4094 completely configured and has not been removed since then.
4097 <tag><var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
4098 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4100 Called during error handling of an upgrade that failed after
4101 unpacking the new package because the <tt>postrm
4102 upgrade</tt> action failed. The unpacked files may be
4103 partly from the new version or partly missing, so the script
4104 cannot rely on files included in the package. Package
4105 dependencies may not be available. Pre-dependencies will be
4106 at least "Unpacked" following the same rules as above, except
4107 they may be only "Half-Installed" if an upgrade of the
4108 pre-dependency failed.<footnote>
4109 This can happen if the new version of the package no
4110 longer pre-depends on a package that had been partially
4118 The <prgn>postinst</prgn> script may be called in the following
4121 <tag><var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
4122 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var></tag>
4124 The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All
4125 package dependencies will at least be "Unpacked". If there
4126 are no circular dependencies involved, all package
4127 dependencies will be configured. For behavior in the case
4128 of circular dependencies, see the discussion
4129 in <ref id="binarydeps">.
4132 <tag><var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
4133 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4134 <tag><var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
4135 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
4136 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4137 <tag><var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt></tag>
4138 <tag><var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
4139 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
4140 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
4141 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
4142 <var>version</var>]</tag>
4144 The files contained in the package will be unpacked. All
4145 package dependencies will at least be "Half-Installed" and
4146 will have previously been configured and not removed.
4147 However, dependencies may not be configured or even fully
4148 unpacked in some error situations.<footnote>
4149 For example, suppose packages foo and bar are "Installed"
4150 with foo depending on bar. If an upgrade of bar were
4151 started and then aborted, and then an attempt to remove
4152 foo failed because its <prgn>prerm</prgn> script failed,
4153 foo's <tt>postinst abort-remove</tt> would be called with
4154 bar only "Half-Installed".
4156 The <prgn>postinst</prgn> should still attempt any actions
4157 for which its dependencies are required, since they will
4158 normally be available, but consider the correct error
4159 handling approach if those actions fail. Aborting
4160 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> action if commands or facilities
4161 from the package dependencies are not available is often the
4168 The <prgn>prerm</prgn> script may be called in the following
4171 <tag><var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt></tag>
4172 <tag><var>old-prerm</var>
4173 <tt>upgrade</tt><var>new-version</var></tag>
4174 <tag><var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
4175 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
4176 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4177 <tag><var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
4178 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
4179 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
4180 <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>]</tag>
4182 The package whose <prgn>prerm</prgn> is being called will be
4183 at least "Half-Installed". All package dependencies will at
4184 least be "Half-Installed" and will have previously been
4185 configured and not removed. If there was no error, all
4186 dependencies will at least be "Unpacked", but these actions
4187 may be called in various error states where dependencies are
4188 only "Half-Installed" due to a partial upgrade.
4191 <tag><var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
4192 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4194 Called during error handling when <tt>prerm upgrade</tt>
4195 fails. The new package will not yet be unpacked, and all
4196 the same constraints as for <tt>preinst upgrade</tt> apply.
4202 The <prgn>postrm</prgn> script may be called in the following
4205 <tag><var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt></tag>
4206 <tag><var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt></tag>
4207 <tag><var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
4208 <var>new-version</var></tag>
4209 <tag><var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
4210 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var></tag>
4212 The <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is called after the package's
4213 files have been removed or replaced. The package
4214 whose <prgn>postrm</prgn> is being called may have
4215 previously been deconfigured and only be "Unpacked", at which
4216 point subsequent package changes do not consider its
4217 dependencies. Therefore, all <prgn>postrm</prgn> actions
4218 may only rely on essential packages and must gracefully skip
4219 any actions that require the package's dependencies if those
4220 dependencies are unavailable.<footnote>
4221 This is often done by checking whether the command or
4222 facility the <prgn>postrm</prgn> intends to call is
4223 available before calling it. For example:
4225 if [ "$1" = purge ] && [ -e /usr/share/debconf/confmodule ]; then
4226 . /usr/share/debconf/confmodule
4230 in <prgn>postrm</prgn> purges the <prgn>debconf</prgn>
4231 configuration for the package
4232 if <package>debconf</package> is installed.
4236 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
4237 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4239 Called when the old <tt>postrm upgrade</tt> action fails.
4240 The new package will be unpacked, but only essential
4241 packages and pre-dependencies can be relied on.
4242 Pre-dependencies will either be configured or will be
4243 "Unpacked" or "Half-Configured" but previously had been
4244 configured and was never removed.
4247 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt></tag>
4248 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
4249 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4250 <tag><var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
4251 <var>old-version</var></tag>
4253 Called before unpacking the new package as part of the
4254 error handling of <prgn>preinst</prgn> failures. May assume
4255 the same state as <prgn>preinst</prgn> can assume.
4261 <sect id="unpackphase">
4262 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
4265 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
4266 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
4267 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
4268 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
4269 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
4270 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
4271 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
4278 If a version of the package is already "Installed", call
4279 <example compact="compact">
4280 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4284 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
4285 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4286 <example compact="compact">
4287 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4289 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
4290 does not work, the error unwind:
4291 <example compact="compact">
4292 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4294 If this works, then the old-version is
4295 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
4296 "Half-Configured" state.
4302 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
4303 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
4306 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
4307 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
4308 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
4309 <example compact="compact">
4310 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
4311 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
4314 <example compact="compact">
4315 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
4316 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
4318 The deconfigured packages are marked as
4319 requiring configuration, so that if
4320 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
4321 configured again if possible.
4324 If any packages depended on a conflicting
4325 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
4326 specified, call, for each such package:
4327 <example compact="compact">
4328 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
4329 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
4330 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
4333 <example compact="compact">
4334 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
4335 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
4336 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
4338 The deconfigured packages are marked as
4339 requiring configuration, so that if
4340 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
4341 configured again if possible.
4344 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
4345 <example compact="compact">
4346 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
4347 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4350 <example compact="compact">
4351 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4352 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4361 If the package is being upgraded, call:
4362 <example compact="compact">
4363 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4365 If this fails, we call:
4367 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4374 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4376 is called. If this works, then the old version
4377 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
4378 in an "Unpacked" state.
4383 If it fails, then the old version is left
4384 in an "Half-Installed" state.
4391 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
4392 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
4393 is in the "Config-Files" state):
4394 <example compact="compact">
4395 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
4399 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
4401 If this fails, the package is left in a
4402 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
4403 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
4404 a "Config-Files" state.
4407 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
4408 <example compact="compact">
4409 <var>new-preinst</var> install
4412 <example compact="compact">
4413 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
4415 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
4416 "Half-Installed" phase, and requires a
4417 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
4418 package is in the "Not-Installed" state.
4425 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
4426 that may be on the system already, for example any
4427 from the old version of the same package or from
4428 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
4429 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
4430 management system will attempt to put them back as
4431 part of the error unwind.
4435 It is an error for a package to contain files which
4436 are on the system in another package, unless
4437 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
4439 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
4440 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
4441 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
4447 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
4448 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
4449 package has a directory (again, unless
4450 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
4451 overridden if desired using
4452 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
4457 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
4458 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
4459 system administrator to understand. It can easily
4460 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
4461 is unpacked which overwrites a file from another
4462 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
4463 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
4464 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
4469 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
4470 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
4471 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
4472 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
4481 If the package is being upgraded, call
4482 <example compact="compact">
4483 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4487 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4488 <example compact="compact">
4489 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4491 If this works, installation continues. If not,
4493 <example compact="compact">
4494 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4496 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4497 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4499 <example compact="compact">
4500 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4502 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4503 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4505 <example compact="compact">
4506 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4508 If this fails, the old version is in an
4515 This is the point of no return - if
4516 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
4517 past this point if an error occurs. This will
4518 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
4519 will require a successful re-installation to clear
4520 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
4521 things that are irreversible.
4526 Any files which were in the old version of the package
4527 but not in the new are removed.
4531 The new file list replaces the old.
4535 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
4539 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
4540 during the installation, and which aren't required for
4541 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
4542 For each such package
4545 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
4546 <example compact="compact">
4547 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
4548 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
4552 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
4555 It is noted in the status database as being in a
4556 sane state, namely "Not-Installed" (any conffiles
4557 it may have are ignored, rather than being
4558 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
4559 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
4560 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
4561 in advance that the package is going to
4568 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
4569 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
4570 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
4571 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
4575 The backup files made during installation, above, are
4581 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
4586 Here is another point of no return - if the
4587 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
4588 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
4589 is left in a half-removed limbo.
4594 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
4595 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4596 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4597 are also in the package being unpacked have already
4598 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4599 and so do not get removed now).
4605 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4608 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4609 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4610 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4611 <example compact="compact">
4612 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4617 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4618 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4619 a "Half-Configured" state, and an error message is generated.
4623 If there is no most recently configured version
4624 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4627 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4628 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt><unknown></tt>
4629 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4630 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4631 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4632 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4633 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4639 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4640 configuration purging</heading>
4646 <example compact="compact">
4647 <var>prerm</var> remove
4651 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4653 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4654 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4658 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4662 If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured"
4663 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4667 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4670 <example compact="compact">
4671 <var>postrm</var> remove
4675 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4676 an "Half-Installed" state.
4681 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4686 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4687 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4688 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4689 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4690 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4694 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4695 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4696 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4701 <example compact="compact">
4702 <var>postrm</var> purge
4706 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4711 The package's file list is removed.
4720 <chapt id="relationships">
4721 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4723 <sect id="depsyntax">
4724 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4727 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4728 package names separated by commas.
4732 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4733 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4734 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4735 control fields of the package, which declare
4736 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4737 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4738 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4739 that part of the dependency can be satisfied by any one of
4740 the alternative packages.
4744 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4745 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4746 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4747 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4748 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4749 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4753 The relations allowed are <tt><<</tt>, <tt><=</tt>,
4754 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>>=</tt> and <tt>>></tt> for strictly
4755 earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or equal and
4756 strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4757 forms <tt><</tt> and <tt>></tt> were confusingly used to
4758 mean earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4759 and must not appear in new packages (though <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
4760 still supports them with a warning).
4764 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4765 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4766 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4767 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4768 relationship fields can only be folded in source package control files. For
4769 consistency and in case of future changes to
4770 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4771 used after a version relationship and before a version
4772 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4773 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4774 each open parenthesis. When opening a continuation line in a relationship field, it
4775 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4776 following that comma.
4780 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4781 <example compact="compact">
4784 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4789 Relationships may be restricted to a certain set of
4790 architectures. This is indicated in brackets after each
4791 individual package name and the optional version specification.
4792 The brackets enclose a non-empty list of Debian architecture names
4793 in the format described in <ref id="arch-spec">,
4794 separated by whitespace. Exclamation marks may be prepended to
4795 each of the names. (It is not permitted for some names to be
4796 prepended with exclamation marks while others aren't.)
4800 For build relationship fields
4801 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4802 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>), if
4803 the current Debian host architecture is not in this list and
4804 there are no exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list
4805 with a prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4806 associated version specification are ignored completely for the
4807 purposes of defining the relationships.
4812 <example compact="compact">
4814 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4815 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4816 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4818 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4819 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4820 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4824 For binary relationship fields and the <tt>Built-Using</tt>
4825 field, the architecture restriction
4826 syntax is only supported in the source package control
4827 file <file>debian/control</file>. When the corresponding binary
4828 package control file is generated, the relationship will either
4829 be omitted or included without the architecture restriction
4830 based on the architecture of the binary package. This means
4831 that architecture restrictions must not be used in binary
4832 relationship fields for architecture-independent packages
4833 (<tt>Architecture: all</tt>).
4838 <example compact="compact">
4839 Depends: foo [i386], bar [amd64]
4841 becomes <tt>Depends: foo</tt> when the package is built on
4842 the <tt>i386</tt> architecture, <tt>Depends: bar</tt> when the
4843 package is built on the <tt>amd64</tt> architecture, and omitted
4844 entirely in binary packages built on all other architectures.
4848 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4849 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4850 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4852 <example compact="compact">
4853 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4855 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4856 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4857 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4861 Relationships may also be restricted to a certain set of
4862 architectures using architecture wildcards in the format
4863 described in <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">. The syntax for
4864 declaring such restrictions is the same as declaring
4865 restrictions using a certain set of architectures without
4866 architecture wildcards. For example:
4867 <example compact="compact">
4868 Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
4870 is equivalent to <tt>foo</tt> on architectures using the Linux
4871 kernel and any cpu, <tt>bar</tt> on architectures using any
4872 kernel and an i386 cpu, and <tt>baz</tt> on any architecture
4873 using a kernel other than Linux.
4877 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4878 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4879 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4880 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4881 source package section of the control file (which is the
4886 <sect id="binarydeps">
4887 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4888 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4889 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4893 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4894 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4895 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4896 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4900 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4901 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4902 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control fields.
4903 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4904 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4905 rest are described below.
4909 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4910 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4911 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4912 depending (binary) package's control file.
4913 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4914 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4915 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4920 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4921 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4922 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4923 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4924 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4925 properly installed with a different version whose
4926 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4927 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4928 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4929 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4930 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4931 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4932 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4933 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4934 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4935 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4936 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4940 Since <tt>Depends</tt> only places requirements on the order in
4941 which packages are configured, packages in an installation run
4942 are usually all unpacked first and all configured later.
4944 This approach makes dependency resolution easier. If two
4945 packages A and B are being upgraded, the installed package A
4946 depends on exactly the installed package B, and the new
4947 package A depends on exactly the new package B (a common
4948 situation when upgrading shared libraries and their
4949 corresponding development packages), satisfying the
4950 dependencies at every stage of the upgrade would be
4951 impossible. This relaxed restriction means that both new
4952 packages can be unpacked together and then configured in their
4958 If there is a circular dependency among packages being installed
4959 or removed, installation or removal order honoring the
4960 dependency order is impossible, requiring the dependency loop be
4961 broken at some point and the dependency requirements violated
4962 for at least one package. Packages involved in circular
4963 dependencies may not be able to rely on their dependencies being
4964 configured before they themselves are configured, depending on
4965 which side of the break of the circular dependency loop they
4966 happen to be on. If one of the packages in the loop has
4967 no <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, then the cycle will be broken
4968 at that package; this ensures that all <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4969 scripts are run with their dependencies properly configured if
4970 this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point is arbitrary.
4971 Packages should therefore avoid circular dependencies where
4972 possible, particularly if they have <prgn>postinst</prgn>
4977 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4979 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4982 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4983 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4984 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4985 configured (unless there is a circular dependency as
4990 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4991 depended-on package is required for the depending
4992 package to provide a significant amount of
4997 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4998 <prgn>postinst</prgn> or <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts
4999 require the depended-on package to be unpacked or
5000 configured in order to run. In the case of <tt>postinst
5001 configure</tt>, the depended-on packages will be unpacked
5002 and configured first. (If both packages are involved in a
5003 dependency loop, this might not work as expected; see the
5004 explanation a few paragraphs back.) In the case
5005 of <prgn>prerm</prgn> or other <prgn>postinst</prgn>
5006 actions, the package dependencies will normally be at
5007 least unpacked, but they may be only "Half-Installed" if a
5008 previous upgrade of the dependency failed.
5012 Finally, the <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
5013 depended-on package is needed by the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
5014 script to fully clean up after the package removal. There
5015 is no guarantee that package dependencies will be
5016 available when <prgn>postrm</prgn> is run, but the
5017 depended-on package is more likely to be available if the
5018 package declares a dependency (particularly in the case
5019 of <tt>postrm remove</tt>). The <prgn>postrm</prgn>
5020 script must gracefully skip actions that require a
5021 dependency if that dependency isn't available.
5025 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
5028 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
5032 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
5033 that would be found together with this one in all but
5034 unusual installations.
5038 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
5040 This is used to declare that one package may be more
5041 useful with one or more others. Using this field
5042 tells the packaging system and the user that the
5043 listed packages are related to this one and can
5044 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
5045 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
5048 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
5050 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
5051 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
5052 package can enhance the functionality of another
5056 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
5059 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
5060 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
5061 of the packages named before even starting the
5062 installation of the package which declares the
5063 pre-dependency, as follows:
5067 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
5068 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
5069 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
5070 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
5071 package(s) are only in the "Unpacked" or the "Half-Configured"
5072 state, provided that they have been configured
5073 correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
5074 or partially removed since). In this case, both the
5075 previously-configured and currently "Unpacked" or
5076 "Half-Configured" versions must satisfy any version
5077 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
5081 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
5082 be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be treated
5083 as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>. It will be considered
5084 satisfied only if the depended-on package has been
5085 correctly configured. However, unlike
5086 with <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> does not
5087 permit circular dependencies to be broken. If a circular
5088 dependency is encountered while attempting to honor
5089 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, the installation will be aborted.
5093 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
5094 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named package.
5095 It is best to avoid this situation if possible.
5099 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
5100 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
5101 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
5102 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
5106 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
5107 package before this has been discussed on the
5108 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
5109 doing that has been reached. See <ref id="dependencies">.
5116 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
5117 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
5118 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
5119 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
5120 importance. Such a package should list using
5121 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
5122 more important components. The other components'
5123 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
5124 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
5130 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
5133 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
5134 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
5135 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> to be unpacked unless the broken
5136 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
5137 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
5141 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
5142 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
5143 be at least "Half-Installed".
5147 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
5148 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
5149 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
5154 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
5155 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
5156 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which violates
5157 an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions of the broken
5158 package, or which takes over a file from earlier versions of the
5159 package named in <tt>Breaks</tt>. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt>
5160 will inform higher-level package management tools that the
5161 broken package must be upgraded before the new one.
5165 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
5166 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> to ensure this
5167 goes smoothly. See <ref id="replaces"> for a full discussion
5168 of taking over files from other packages, including how to
5169 use <tt>Breaks</tt> in those cases.
5173 Many of the cases where <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used were
5174 previously handled with <tt>Conflicts</tt>
5175 because <tt>Breaks</tt> did not yet exist.
5176 Many <tt>Conflicts</tt> fields should now be <tt>Breaks</tt>.
5177 See <ref id="conflicts"> for more information about the
5182 <sect id="conflicts">
5183 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
5186 When one binary package declares a conflict with another using
5187 a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to
5188 allow them to be unpacked on the system at the same time. This
5189 is a stronger restriction than <tt>Breaks</tt>, which prevents
5190 the broken package from being configured while the breaking
5191 package is in the "Unpacked" state but allows both packages to
5192 be unpacked at the same time.
5196 If one package is to be unpacked, the other must be removed
5197 first. If the package being unpacked is marked as replacing
5198 (see <ref id="replaces">, but note that <tt>Breaks</tt> should
5199 normally be used in this case) the one on the system, or the one
5200 on the system is marked as deselected, or both packages are
5201 marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
5202 automatically remove the package which is causing the conflict.
5203 Otherwise, it will halt the installation of the new package with
5204 an error. This mechanism is specifically designed to produce an
5205 error when the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the
5210 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
5211 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
5216 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
5217 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
5218 package which they provide (see below): this does not
5219 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
5220 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
5221 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
5222 package providing some feature.
5226 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used instead
5227 of <tt>Conflicts</tt> since <tt>Conflicts</tt> imposes a
5228 stronger restriction on the ordering of package installation or
5229 upgrade and can make it more difficult for the package manager
5230 to find a correct solution to an upgrade or installation
5231 problem. <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used
5233 <item>when moving a file from one package to another (see
5234 <ref id="replaces">),</item>
5235 <item>when splitting a package (a special case of the previous
5237 <item>when the breaking package exposes a bug in or interacts
5238 badly with particular versions of the broken
5241 <tt>Conflicts</tt> should be used
5243 <item>when two packages provide the same file and will
5244 continue to do so,</item>
5245 <item>in conjunction with <tt>Provides</tt> when only one
5246 package providing a given virtual facility may be unpacked
5247 at a time (see <ref id="virtual">),</item>
5248 <item>in other cases where one must prevent simultaneous
5249 installation of two packages for reasons that are ongoing
5250 (not fixed in a later version of one of the packages) or
5251 that must prevent both packages from being unpacked at the
5252 same time, not just configured.</item>
5254 Be aware that adding <tt>Conflicts</tt> is normally not the best
5255 solution when two packages provide the same files. Depending on
5256 the reason for that conflict, using alternatives or renaming the
5257 files is often a better approach. See, for
5258 example, <ref id="binaries">.
5262 Neither <tt>Breaks</tt> nor <tt>Conflicts</tt> should be used
5263 unless two packages cannot be installed at the same time or
5264 installing them both causes one of them to be broken or
5265 unusable. Having similar functionality or performing the same
5266 tasks as another package is not sufficient reason to
5267 declare <tt>Breaks</tt> or <tt>Conflicts</tt> with that package.
5271 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry may have an "earlier than" version
5272 clause if the reason for the conflict is corrected in a later
5273 version of one of the packages. However, normally the presence
5274 of an "earlier than" version clause is a sign
5275 that <tt>Breaks</tt> should have been used instead. An "earlier
5276 than" version clause in <tt>Conflicts</tt>
5277 prevents <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the
5278 package which declares such a conflict until the upgrade or
5279 removal of the conflicted-with package has been completed, which
5280 is a strong restriction.
5284 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
5288 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
5289 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
5290 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
5291 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
5292 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
5293 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
5294 may mention "virtual packages".
5298 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
5299 <tt>Provides</tt> control field of another package. The effect
5300 is as if the package(s) which provide a particular virtual
5301 package name had been listed by name everywhere the virtual
5302 package name appears. (See also <ref id="virtual_pkg">)
5306 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
5307 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
5308 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
5309 question or any other concrete package which provides the
5310 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
5311 for example, supposing we have
5312 <example compact="compact">
5315 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
5316 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
5317 <example compact="compact">
5321 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
5322 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
5326 If a relationship field has a version number attached, only real
5327 packages will be considered to see whether the relationship is
5328 satisfied (or the prohibition violated, for a conflict or
5329 breakage). In other words, if a version number is specified,
5330 this is a request to ignore all <tt>Provides</tt> for that
5331 package name and consider only real packages. The package
5332 manager will assume that a package providing that virtual
5333 package is not of the "right" version. A <tt>Provides</tt>
5334 field may not contain version numbers, and the version number of
5335 the concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
5336 will not be considered when considering a dependency on or
5337 conflict with the virtual package name.<footnote>
5338 It is possible that a future release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> may
5339 add the ability to specify a version number for each virtual
5340 package it provides. This feature is not yet present,
5341 however, and is expected to be used only infrequently.
5346 To specify which of a set of real packages should be the default
5347 to satisfy a particular dependency on a virtual package, list
5348 the real package as an alternative before the virtual one.
5352 If the virtual package represents a facility that can only be
5353 provided by one real package at a time, such as
5354 the <package>mail-transport-agent</package> virtual package that
5355 requires installation of a binary that would conflict with all
5356 other providers of that virtual package (see
5357 <ref id="mail-transport-agents">), all packages providing that
5358 virtual package should also declare a conflict with it
5359 using <tt>Conflicts</tt>. This will ensure that at most one
5360 provider of that virtual package is unpacked or installed at a
5365 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
5366 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
5369 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
5370 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely replace
5371 other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control field has these
5372 two distinct purposes.
5375 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
5378 It is usually an error for a package to contain files which
5379 are on the system in another package. However, if the
5380 overwriting package declares that it <tt>Replaces</tt> the one
5381 containing the file being overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5382 will replace the file from the old package with that from the
5383 new. The file will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old
5384 package and will be taken over by the new package.
5385 Normally, <tt>Breaks</tt> should be used in conjunction
5386 with <tt>Replaces</tt>.<footnote>
5387 To see why <tt>Breaks</tt> is normally needed in addition
5388 to <tt>Replaces</tt>, consider the case of a file in the
5389 package <package>foo</package> being taken over by the
5390 package <package>foo-data</package>.
5391 <tt>Replaces</tt> will allow <package>foo-data</package> to
5392 be installed and take over that file. However,
5393 without <tt>Breaks</tt>, nothing
5394 requires <package>foo</package> to be upgraded to a newer
5395 version that knows it does not include that file and instead
5396 depends on <package>foo-data</package>. Nothing would
5397 prevent the new <package>foo-data</package> package from
5398 being installed and then removed, removing the file that it
5399 took over from <package>foo</package>. After that
5400 operation, the package manager would think the system was in
5401 a consistent state, but the <package>foo</package> package
5402 would be missing one of its files.
5407 For example, if a package <package>foo</package> is split
5408 into <package>foo</package> and <package>foo-data</package>
5409 starting at version 1.2-3, <package>foo-data</package> would
5411 <example compact="compact">
5412 Replaces: foo (<< 1.2-3)
5413 Breaks: foo (<< 1.2-3)
5415 in its control file. The new version of the
5416 package <package>foo</package> would normally have the field
5417 <example compact="compact">
5418 Depends: foo-data (>= 1.2-3)
5420 (or possibly <tt>Recommends</tt> or even <tt>Suggests</tt> if
5421 the files moved into <package>foo-data</package> are not
5422 required for normal operation).
5426 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
5427 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
5428 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
5429 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
5430 removal) and "Not-Installed". Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
5431 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
5432 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
5433 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
5434 special argument to allow the package to do any final
5435 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
5437 Replaces is a one way relationship. You have to install
5438 the replacing package after the replaced package.
5443 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
5444 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
5445 <tt>Replaces</tt> field. The packages declared as being
5446 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
5450 This usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes effect when both
5451 packages are at least partially on the system at once. It is
5452 not relevant if the packages conflict unless the conflict has
5457 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
5461 Second, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
5462 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
5463 conflict (see <ref id="conflicts">). This usage only takes
5464 effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict, so that the
5465 two usages of this field do not interfere with each other.
5469 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
5470 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
5471 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
5472 their control files:
5473 <example compact="compact">
5474 Provides: mail-transport-agent
5475 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
5476 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
5478 ensuring that only one MTA can be unpacked at any one
5479 time. See <ref id="virtual"> for more information about this
5484 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
5485 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
5486 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
5487 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
5491 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
5492 installed or absent at the time of building the package
5493 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
5497 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
5498 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
5499 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control fields.
5503 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
5504 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
5508 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
5509 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
5510 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
5512 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
5513 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
5514 <tt>build-indep</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets is
5515 assumed to be building the whole package, and therefore
5516 installation of all build dependencies is required.
5519 The autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
5520 calls <tt>build</tt>, not <tt>build-arch</tt> since it does
5521 not yet know how to check for its existence, and
5522 <tt>binary-arch</tt>. The purpose of the original split
5523 between <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
5524 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> was so that the autobuilders
5525 wouldn't need to install extra packages needed only for the
5526 binary-indep targets. But without a build-arch/build-indep
5527 split, this didn't work, since most of the work is done in
5528 the build target, not in the binary target.
5532 <tag><tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>, and
5533 <tt>binary-arch</tt></tag>
5535 Only the <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>
5536 fields must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
5538 <tag><tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
5539 and <tt>binary-indep</tt></tag>
5541 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>,
5542 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, and
5543 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be satisfied when
5544 these targets are invoked.
5550 <sect id="built-using">
5551 <heading>Additional source packages used to build the binary
5552 - <tt>Built-Using</tt>
5556 Some binary packages incorporate parts of other packages when built
5557 but do not have to depend on those packages. Examples include
5558 linking with static libraries or incorporating source code from
5559 another package during the build. In this case, the source packages
5560 of those other packages are a required part of the complete source
5561 (the binary package is not reproducible without them).
5565 A <tt>Built-Using</tt> field must list the corresponding source
5566 package for any such binary package incorporated during the build
5568 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> in the source package is not adequate since
5569 it (rightfully) does not document the exact version used in the
5572 including an "exactly equal" ("=") version relation on the version
5573 that was used to build that binary package<footnote>
5574 The archive software might reject packages that refer to
5575 non-existent sources.
5580 A package using the source code from the gcc-4.6-source
5581 binary package built from the gcc-4.6 source package would
5582 have this field in its control file:
5583 <example compact="compact">
5584 Built-Using: gcc-4.6 (= 4.6.0-11)
5589 A package including binaries from grub2 and loadlin would
5590 have this field in its control file:
5591 <example compact="compact">
5592 Built-Using: grub2 (= 1.99-9), loadlin (= 1.6e-1)
5599 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
5602 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
5603 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
5604 available. This is especially important for packages whose
5605 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
5606 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
5610 This section deals only with public shared libraries: shared
5611 libraries that are placed in directories searched by the dynamic
5612 linker by default or which are intended to be linked against
5613 normally and possibly used by other, independent packages. Shared
5614 libraries that are internal to a particular package or that are
5615 only loaded as dynamic modules are not covered by this section and
5616 are not subject to its requirements.
5620 A shared library is identified by the <tt>SONAME</tt> attribute
5621 stored in its dynamic section. When a binary is linked against a
5622 shared library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared library is
5623 recorded in the binary's <tt>NEEDED</tt> section so that the
5624 dynamic linker knows that library must be loaded at runtime. The
5625 shared library file's full name (which usually contains additional
5626 version information not needed in the <tt>SONAME</tt>) is
5627 therefore normally not referenced directly. Instead, the shared
5628 library is loaded by its <tt>SONAME</tt>, which exists on the file
5629 system as a symlink pointing to the full name of the shared
5630 library. This symlink must be provided by the
5631 package. <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> describes how to do this.
5633 This is a convention of shared library versioning, but not a
5634 requirement. Some libraries use the <tt>SONAME</tt> as the full
5635 library file name instead and therefore do not need a symlink.
5636 Most, however, encode additional information about
5637 backwards-compatible revisions as a minor version number in the
5638 file name. The <tt>SONAME</tt> itself only changes when
5639 binaries linked with the earlier version of the shared library
5640 may no longer work, but the filename may change with each
5641 release of the library. See <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> for
5647 When linking a binary or another shared library against a shared
5648 library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> for that shared library is not yet
5649 known. Instead, the shared library is found by looking for a file
5650 matching the library name with <tt>.so</tt> appended. This file
5651 exists on the file system as a symlink pointing to the shared
5656 Shared libraries are normally split into several binary packages.
5657 The <tt>SONAME</tt> symlink is installed by the runtime shared
5658 library package, and the bare <tt>.so</tt> symlink is installed in
5659 the development package since it's only used when linking binaries
5660 or shared libraries. However, there are some exceptions for
5661 unusual shared libraries or for shared libraries that are also
5662 loaded as dynamic modules by other programs.
5666 This section is primarily concerned with how the separation of
5667 shared libraries into multiple packages should be done and how
5668 dependencies on and between shared library binary packages are
5669 managed in Debian. <ref id="libraries"> should be read in
5670 conjunction with this section and contains additional rules for
5671 the files contained in the shared library packages.
5674 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
5675 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
5678 The run-time shared library must be placed in a package
5679 whose name changes whenever the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared
5680 library changes. This allows several versions of the shared
5681 library to be installed at the same time, allowing installation
5682 of the new version of the shared library without immediately
5683 breaking binaries that depend on the old version. Normally, the
5684 run-time shared library and its <tt>SONAME</tt> symlink should
5685 be placed in a package named
5686 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
5687 where <var>soversion</var> is the version number in
5688 the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the shared library. Alternatively, if it
5689 would be confusing to directly append <var>soversion</var>
5690 to <var>libraryname</var> (if, for
5691 example, <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you
5693 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package>
5698 To determine the <var>soversion</var>, look at
5699 the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the library, stored in the
5700 ELF <tt>SONAME</tt> attribute. It is usually of the
5701 form <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt> (for
5702 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>). The version part is the part
5703 which comes after <tt>.so.</tt>, so in that example it
5704 is <tt>1</tt>. The soname may instead be of the
5705 form <tt><var>name</var>-<var>major-version</var>.so</tt>, such
5706 as <tt>libdb-5.1.so</tt>, in which case the name would
5707 be <tt>libdb</tt> and the version would be <tt>5.1</tt>.
5711 If you have several shared libraries built from the same source
5712 tree, you may lump them all together into a single shared
5713 library package provided that all of their <tt>SONAME</tt>s will
5714 always change together. Be aware that this is not normally the
5715 case, and if the <tt>SONAME</tt>s do not change together,
5716 upgrading such a merged shared library package will be
5717 unnecessarily difficult because of file conflicts with the old
5718 version of the package. When in doubt, always split shared
5719 library packages so that each binary package installs a single
5724 Every time the shared library ABI changes in a way that may
5725 break binaries linked against older versions of the shared
5726 library, the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the library and the
5727 corresponding name for the binary package containing the runtime
5728 shared library should change. Normally, this means
5729 the <tt>SONAME</tt> should change any time an interface is
5730 removed from the shared library or the signature of an interface
5731 (the number of parameters or the types of parameters that it
5732 takes, for example) is changed. This practice is vital to
5733 allowing clean upgrades from older versions of the package and
5734 clean transitions between the old ABI and new ABI without having
5735 to upgrade every affected package simultaneously.
5739 The <tt>SONAME</tt> and binary package name need not, and indeed
5740 normally should not, change if new interfaces are added but none
5741 are removed or changed, since this will not break binaries
5742 linked against the old shared library. Correct versioning of
5743 dependencies on the newer shared library by binaries that use
5744 the new interfaces is handled via
5745 the <qref id="sharedlibs-depends"><tt>symbols</tt>
5746 or <tt>shlibs</tt> system</qref>.
5750 The package should install the shared libraries under
5751 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
5752 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
5753 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
5754 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
5755 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
5756 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
5757 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
5762 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
5763 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
5764 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
5768 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link for
5769 the <tt>SONAME</tt> that <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for
5770 the shared libraries. For example,
5771 the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include a symbolic
5772 link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
5773 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
5774 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
5775 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
5776 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
5777 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
5779 The package management system requires the library to be
5780 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
5781 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
5782 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
5783 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
5784 version of the library), the new shared library is already
5785 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
5786 library in the temporary packaging directory before
5787 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
5788 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
5789 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
5790 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
5791 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
5792 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5793 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
5794 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
5795 oneself with the order of file creation.
5799 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
5800 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
5803 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
5804 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
5805 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
5806 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
5807 These are currently <file>/usr/local/lib</file> plus
5808 directories under <file>/lib</file> and <file>/usr/lib</file>
5809 matching the multiarch triplet for the system architecture.
5811 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
5816 The package maintainer scripts must only call
5817 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
5818 <list compact="compact">
5819 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
5820 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
5821 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
5822 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
5824 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
5825 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
5826 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
5831 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
5832 the new files are unpacked, so calling "ldconfig" is
5833 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
5834 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
5835 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
5836 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
5837 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
5842 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
5843 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
5844 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
5845 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
5846 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
5847 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
5848 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
5849 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
5854 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
5855 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
5856 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
5857 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
5858 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
5862 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
5863 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
5864 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
5865 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
5866 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
5867 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
5868 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
5869 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
5870 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
5871 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
5872 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
5880 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
5881 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
5884 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
5885 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
5886 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
5887 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
5888 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
5889 unnecessarily difficult.
5893 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
5894 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
5895 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
5896 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
5897 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
5898 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
5899 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
5900 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
5901 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
5902 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5903 names change when the shared object version changes.
5907 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5908 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5909 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5910 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5911 This package might typically be named
5912 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5913 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5917 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5918 against the library should be included in the development
5919 package for the library.<footnote>
5920 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5921 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5926 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5927 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5930 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5931 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5932 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5936 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5937 available in static form only; these cases include:
5939 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5940 is immature or unstable</item>
5941 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5942 development (commonly the case when the library's
5943 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5944 across patchlevels)</item>
5945 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5946 available only in static form by their upstream
5951 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5952 <heading>Development files</heading>
5955 If there are development files associated with a shared library,
5956 the source package needs to generate a binary development package
5957 named <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5958 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5959 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>. Installing
5960 the development package must result in installation of all the
5961 development files necessary for compiling programs against that
5962 shared library.<footnote>
5963 This wording allows the development files to be split into
5964 several packages, such as a separate architecture-independent
5965 <package><var>libraryname</var>-headers</package>, provided that
5966 the development package depends on all the required additional
5972 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5973 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5974 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5975 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5976 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5977 filename clash if both were unpacked).
5981 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5982 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5983 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5984 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5985 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5986 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5987 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5991 If the package provides Ada Library Information
5992 (<file>*.ali</file>) files for use with GNAT, these files must be
5993 installed read-only (mode 0444) so that GNAT will not attempt to
5994 recompile them. This overrides the normal file mode requirements
5995 given in <ref id="permissions-owners">.
5999 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
6000 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
6003 Typically the development version should have an exact
6004 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
6005 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
6006 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
6007 useful for this purpose.
6009 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
6010 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
6015 <sect id="sharedlibs-depends">
6016 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other
6020 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
6021 shared library, we must ensure that, when the package is
6022 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are also
6023 installed. These dependencies must be added to the binary
6024 package when it is built, since they may change based on which
6025 version of a shared library the binary or library was linked
6026 with even if there are no changes to the source of the binary
6027 (for example, symbol versions change, macros become functions or
6028 vice versa, or the binary package may determine at compile-time
6029 whether new library interfaces are available and can be called).
6030 To allow these dependencies to be constructed, shared libraries
6031 must provide either a <file>symbols</file> file or
6032 a <file>shlibs</file> file. These provide information on the
6033 package dependencies required to ensure the presence of
6034 interfaces provided by this library. Any package with binaries
6035 or libraries linking to a shared library must use these files to
6036 determine the required dependencies when it is built. Other
6037 packages which use a shared library (for example using
6038 <tt>dlopen()</tt>) should compute appropriate dependencies
6039 using these files at build time as well.
6043 The two mechanisms differ in the degree of detail that they
6044 provide. A <file>symbols</file> file documents, for each symbol
6045 exported by a library, the minimal version of the package any
6046 binary using this symbol will need. This is typically the
6047 version of the package in which the symbol was introduced. This
6048 information permits detailed analysis of the symbols used by a
6049 particular package and construction of an accurate dependency,
6050 but it requires the package maintainer to track more information
6051 about the shared library.
6055 A <file>shlibs</file> file, in contrast, only documents the last
6056 time the library ABI changed in any way. It only provides
6057 information about the library as a whole, not individual
6058 symbols. When a package is built using a shared library with
6059 only a <file>shlibs</file> file, the generated dependency will
6060 require a version of the shared library equal to or newer than
6061 the version of the last ABI change. This generates
6062 unnecessarily restrictive dependencies compared
6063 to <file>symbols</file> files if none of the symbols used by the
6064 package have changed. This, in turn, may make upgrades
6065 needlessly complex and unnecessarily restrict use of the package
6066 on systems with older versions of the shared libraries.
6070 <file>shlibs</file> files also only support a limited range of
6071 library SONAMEs, making it difficult to use <file>shlibs</file>
6072 files in some unusual corner cases.<footnote>
6073 A <file>shlibs</file> file represents an SONAME as a library
6074 name and version number, such as <tt>libfoo VERSION</tt>,
6075 instead of recording the actual SONAME. If the SONAME doesn't
6076 match one of the two expected formats
6077 (<tt>libfoo-VERSION.so</tt> or <tt>libfoo.so.VERSION</tt>), it
6078 cannot be represented.
6083 <file>symbols</file> files are therefore recommended for most
6084 shared library packages since they provide more accurate
6085 dependencies. For most C libraries, the additional detail
6086 required by <file>symbols</file> files is not too difficult to
6087 maintain. However, maintaining exhaustive symbols information
6088 for a C++ library can be quite onerous, so <file>shlibs</file>
6089 files may be more appropriate for most C++ libraries. Libraries
6090 with a corresponding udeb must also provide
6091 a <file>shlibs</file> file, since the udeb infrastructure does
6092 not use <file>symbols</file> files.
6095 <sect1 id="dpkg-shlibdeps">
6096 <heading>Generating dependencies on shared libraries</heading>
6099 When a package that contains any shared libraries or compiled
6100 binaries is built, it must run <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on
6101 each shared library and compiled binary to determine the
6102 libraries used and hence the dependencies needed by the
6104 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will use a program
6105 like <prgn>objdump</prgn> or <prgn>readelf</prgn> to find
6106 the libraries and the symbols in those libraries directly
6107 needed by the binaries or shared libraries in the package.
6109 To do this, put a call to <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> into
6110 your <file>debian/rules</file> file in the source package.
6111 List all of the compiled binaries, libraries, or loadable
6112 modules in your package.<footnote>
6113 The easiest way to call <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
6114 correctly is to use a package helper framework such
6115 as <package>debhelper</package>. If you are
6116 using <package>debhelper</package>,
6117 the <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
6118 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary packages.
6120 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will use the <file>symbols</file>
6121 or <file>shlibs</file> files installed by the shared libraries
6122 to generate dependency information. The package must then
6123 provide a substitution variable into which the discovered
6124 dependency information can be placed.
6128 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer,
6129 you will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
6130 should use the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by adding
6131 the <tt>-tudeb</tt> option<footnote>
6132 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
6133 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
6135 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of
6136 type <tt>udeb</tt> in the <file>shlibs</file>
6137 file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will fall back to the
6138 regular dependency line.
6142 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> puts the dependency information
6143 into the <file>debian/substvars</file> file by default, which
6144 is then used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need
6145 to place a <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in
6146 the <tt>Depends</tt> field in the control file of every binary
6147 package built by this source package that contains compiled
6148 binaries, libraries, or loadable modules. If you have
6149 multiple binary packages, you will need to
6150 call <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
6151 compiled libraries or binaries. For example, you could use
6152 the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt> utilities to
6153 specify a different <file>substvars</file> file for each
6154 binary package.<footnote>
6155 Again, <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn>
6156 and <prgn>dh_gencontrol</prgn> will handle everything except
6157 the addition of the variable to the control file for you if
6158 you're using <package>debhelper</package>, including
6159 generating separate <file>substvars</file> files for each
6160 binary package and calling <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> with
6161 the appropriate flags.
6166 For more details on <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>,
6167 see <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
6171 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses a
6172 library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked with that
6173 library (that is, the library is listed in the
6174 ELF <tt>NEEDED</tt> attribute, caused by adding <tt>-lbar</tt>
6175 to the link line when the binary is created). Other libraries
6176 that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are
6177 linked <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
6178 linker will load them automatically when it
6179 loads <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on the
6180 libraries it directly uses, but not the libraries it only uses
6181 indirectly. The dependencies for the libraries used
6182 directly will automatically pull in the indirectly-used
6183 libraries. <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will handle this logic
6184 automatically, but package maintainers need to be aware of
6185 this distinction between directly and indirectly using a
6186 library if they have to override its results for some reason.
6188 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
6189 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
6190 supports a new revision of a graphics format called dgf (but
6191 retaining the same major version number) and depends on a
6192 new library package <package>libdgf4</package> instead of
6193 the older <package>libdgf3</package>. If we
6194 used <prgn>ldd</prgn> to add dependencies for every library
6195 directly or indirectly linked with a binary, every package
6196 that uses <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so
6197 it would also depend on <package>libdgf4</package> in order
6198 to retire the older <package>libdgf3</package> package.
6199 Since dependencies are only added based on
6200 ELF <tt>NEEDED</tt> attribute, packages
6201 using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on <tt>libimlib</tt> itself
6202 having the dependency on an appropriate version
6203 of <tt>libdgf</tt> and do not need rebuilding.
6208 <sect1 id="sharedlibs-updates">
6209 <heading>Shared library ABI changes</heading>
6212 Maintaining a shared library package using
6213 either <file>symbols</file> or <file>shlibs</file> files
6214 requires being aware of the exposed ABI of the shared library
6215 and any changes to it. Both <file>symbols</file>
6216 and <file>shlibs</file> files record every change to the ABI
6217 of the shared library; <file>symbols</file> files do so per
6218 public symbol, whereas <file>shlibs</file> files record only
6219 the last change for the entire library.
6223 There are two types of ABI changes: ones that are
6224 backward-compatible and ones that are not. An ABI change is
6225 backward-compatible if any reasonable program or library that
6226 was linked with the previous version of the shared library
6227 will still work correctly with the new version of the shared
6229 An example of an "unreasonable" program is one that uses
6230 library interfaces that are documented as internal and
6231 unsupported. If the only programs or libraries affected by
6232 a change are "unreasonable" ones, other techniques, such as
6233 declaring <tt>Breaks</tt> relationships with affected
6234 packages or treating their usage of the library as bugs in
6235 those packages, may be appropriate instead of changing the
6236 SONAME. However, the default approach is to change the
6237 SONAME for any change to the ABI that could break a program.
6239 Adding new symbols to the shared library is a
6240 backward-compatible change. Removing symbols from the shared
6241 library is not. Changing the behavior of a symbol may or may
6242 not be backward-compatible depending on the change; for
6243 example, changing a function to accept a new enum constant not
6244 previously used by the library is generally
6245 backward-compatible, but changing the members of a struct that
6246 is passed into library functions is generally not unless the
6247 library takes special precautions to accept old versions of
6252 ABI changes that are not backward-compatible normally require
6253 changing the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the library and therefore the
6254 shared library package name, which forces rebuilding all
6255 packages using that shared library to update their
6256 dependencies and allow them to use the new version of the
6257 shared library. For more information,
6258 see <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime">. The remainder of this
6259 section will deal with backward-compatible changes.
6263 Backward-compatible changes require either updating or
6264 recording the <var>minimal-version</var> for that symbol
6265 in <file>symbols</file> files or updating the version in
6266 the <var>dependencies</var> in <file>shlibs</file> files. For
6267 more information on how to do this in the two formats, see
6268 <ref id="symbols"> and <ref id="shlibs">. Below are general
6269 rules that apply to both files.
6273 The easy case is when a public symbol is added. Simply add
6274 the version at which the symbol was introduced
6275 (for <file>symbols</file> files) or update the dependency
6276 version (for <file>shlibs</file>) files. But special care
6277 should be taken to update dependency versions when the
6278 behavior of a public symbol changes. This is easy to neglect,
6279 since there is no automated method of determining such
6280 changes, but failing to update versions in this case may
6281 result in binary packages with too-weak dependencies that will
6282 fail at runtime, possibly in ways that can cause security
6283 vulnerabilities. If the package maintainer believes that a
6284 symbol behavior change may have occurred but isn't sure, it's
6285 safer to update the version rather than leave it unmodified.
6286 This may result in unnecessarily strict dependencies, but it
6287 ensures that packages whose dependencies are satisfied will
6292 A common example of when a change to the dependency version
6293 is required is a function that takes an enum or struct
6294 argument that controls what the function does. For example:
6296 enum library_op { OP_FOO, OP_BAR };
6297 int library_do_operation(enum library_op);
6299 If a new operation, <tt>OP_BAZ</tt>, is added,
6300 the <var>minimal-version</var>
6301 of <tt>library_do_operation</tt> (for <file>symbols</file>
6302 files) or the version in the dependency for the shared library
6303 (for <file>shlibs</file> files) must be increased to the
6304 version at which <tt>OP_BAZ</tt> was introduced. Otherwise, a
6305 binary built against the new version of the library (having
6306 detected at compile-time that the library
6307 supports <tt>OP_BAZ</tt>) may be installed with a shared
6308 library that doesn't support <tt>OP_BAZ</tt> and will fail at
6309 runtime when it tries to pass <tt>OP_BAZ</tt> into this
6314 Dependency versions in either <file>symbols</file>
6315 or <file>shlibs</file> files normally should not contain the
6316 Debian revision of the package, since the library behavior is
6317 normally fixed for a particular upstream version and any
6318 Debian packaging of that upstream version will have the same
6319 behavior. In the rare case that the library behavior was
6320 changed in a particular Debian revision, appending <tt>~</tt>
6321 to the end of the version that includes the Debian revision is
6322 recommended, since this allows backports of the shared library
6323 package using the normal backport versioning convention to
6324 satisfy the dependency.
6328 <sect1 id="sharedlibs-symbols">
6329 <heading>The <tt>symbols</tt> system</heading>
6332 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
6333 various <file>symbols</file> files are to be found, then
6334 the <file>symbols</file> file format, and finally how to
6335 create <file>symbols</file> files if your package contains a
6339 <sect2 id="symbols-paths">
6340 <heading>The <file>symbols</file> files present on the
6344 <file>symbols</file> files for a shared library are normally
6345 provided by the shared library package as a control file,
6346 but there are several override paths that are checked first
6347 in case that information is wrong or missing. The following
6348 list gives them in the order in which they are read
6349 by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> The first one that contains
6350 the required information is used.
6353 <p><file>debian/*/DEBIAN/symbols</file></p>
6356 During the package build, if the package itself
6357 contains shared libraries with <file>symbols</file>
6358 files, they will be generated in these staging
6359 directories by <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn>
6360 (see <ref id="providing-symbols">). <file>symbols</file>
6361 files found in the build tree take precedence
6362 over <file>symbols</file> files from other binary
6367 These files must exist
6368 before <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run or the
6369 dependencies of binaries and libraries from a source
6370 package on other libraries from that same source
6371 package will not be correct. In practice, this means
6372 that <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn> must be run
6373 before <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> during the package
6375 An example may clarify. Suppose the source
6376 package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
6377 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and <tt>foo-runtime</tt>.
6378 When building the binary packages, the contents of
6379 the packages are staged in the
6380 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file>
6381 and <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
6382 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of
6383 one of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides
6384 the <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will contain
6385 a <tt>symbols</tt> file, which will be installed
6386 in <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/symbols</file>,
6387 eventually to be included as a control file in that
6388 package. When <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on
6390 executable <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>,
6392 the <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/symbols</file> file
6393 to determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
6394 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
6395 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. Since those binaries
6396 were linked against the just-built shared library as
6397 part of the build process, the <file>symbols</file>
6398 file for the newly-built <tt>libfoo2</tt> must take
6399 precedence over a <file>symbols</file> file for any
6400 other <tt>libfoo2</tt> package already installed on
6408 <file>/etc/dpkg/symbols/<var>package</var>.symbols.<var>arch</var></file>
6409 and <file>/etc/dpkg/symbols/<var>package</var>.symbols</file>
6413 Per-system overrides of shared library dependencies.
6414 These files normally do not exist. They are
6415 maintained by the local system administrator and must
6416 not be created by any Debian package.
6421 <p><file>symbols</file> control files for packages
6422 installed on the system</p>
6425 The <file>symbols</file> control files for all the
6426 packages currently installed on the system are
6427 searched last. This will be the most common source of
6428 shared library dependency information. These are
6430 in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.symbols</file>, but
6431 packages should not rely on this and instead should
6432 use <tt>dpkg-query --control-path <var>package</var>
6433 symbols</tt> if for some reason these files need to be
6441 Be aware that if a <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> exists
6442 in the source package, it will override
6443 any <file>symbols</file> files. This is the only case where
6444 a <file>shlibs</file> is used despite <file>symbols</file>
6445 files being present. See <ref id="shlibs-paths">
6446 and <ref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps"> for more information.
6450 <sect2 id="symbols">
6451 <heading>The <file>symbols</file> File Format</heading>
6454 The following documents the format of
6455 the <file>symbols</file> control file as included in binary
6456 packages. These files are built from
6457 template <file>symbols</file> files in the source package
6458 by <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn>. The template files support
6459 a richer syntax that allows <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn> to
6460 do some of the tedious work involved in
6461 maintaining <file>symbols</file> files, such as handling C++
6462 symbols or optional symbols that may not exist on particular
6463 architectures. When writing <file>symbols</file> files for
6464 a shared library package, refer
6465 to <manref name="dpkg-gensymbols" section="1"> for the
6470 A <file>symbols</file> may contain one or more entries, one
6471 for each shared library contained in the package
6472 corresponding to that <file>symbols</file>. Each entry has
6473 the following format:
6478 <var>library-soname</var> <var>main-dependency-template</var>
6479 [| <var>alternative-dependency-template</var>]
6481 [* <var>field-name</var>: <var>field-value</var>]
6483 <var>symbol</var> <var>minimal-version</var>[ <var>id-of-dependency-template</var> ]
6488 To explain this format, we'll use the the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
6489 package as an example, which (at the time of writing)
6491 library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4</file>. Mandatory
6492 lines will be described first, followed by optional lines.
6496 <var>library-soname</var> must contain exactly the value of
6497 the ELF <tt>SONAME</tt> attribute of the shared library. In
6498 our example, this is <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
6499 This can be determined by using the command
6500 <example compact="compact">
6501 readelf -d /usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4 | grep SONAME
6507 <var>main-dependency-template</var> has the same syntax as a
6508 dependency field in a binary package control file, except
6509 that the string <tt>#MINVER#</tt> is replaced by a version
6510 restriction like <tt>(>= <var>version</var>)</tt> or by
6511 nothing if an unversioned dependency is deemed sufficient.
6512 The version restriction will be based on which symbols from
6513 the shared library are referenced and the version at which
6514 they were introduced (see below). In nearly all
6515 cases, <var>main-dependency-template</var> will
6516 be <tt><var>package</var> #MINVER#</tt>,
6517 where <var>package</var> is the name of the binary package
6518 containing the shared library. This adds a simple,
6519 possibly-versioned dependency on the shared library package.
6520 In some rare cases, such as when multiple packages provide
6521 the same shared library ABI, the dependency template may
6522 need to be more complex.
6526 In our example, the first line of
6527 the <tt>zlib1g</tt> <file>symbols</file> file would be:
6528 <example compact="compact">
6529 libz.so.1 zlib1g #MINVER#
6534 Each public symbol exported by the shared library must have
6535 a corresponding symbol line, indented by one
6536 space. <var>symbol</var> is the exported symbol (which, for
6537 C++, means the mangled symbol) followed by <tt>@</tt> and
6538 the symbol version, or the string <tt>Base</tt> if there is
6539 no symbol version. <var>minimal-version</var> is the most
6540 recent version of the shared library that changed the
6541 behavior of that symbol, whether by adding it, changing its
6542 function signature (the parameters, their types, or the
6543 return type), or changing its behavior in a way that is
6544 visible to a caller.
6545 <var>id-of-dependency-template</var> is an optional
6546 field that references
6547 an <var>alternative-dependency-template</var>; see below for
6552 For example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt> contains the
6553 symbols <tt>compress</tt>
6554 and <tt>compressBound</tt>. <tt>compress</tt> has no symbol
6555 version and last changed its behavior in upstream
6556 version <tt>1:1.1.4</tt>. <tt>compressBound</tt> has the
6557 symbol version <tt>ZLIB_1.2.0</tt>, was introduced in
6558 upstream version <tt>1:1.2.0</tt>, and has not changed its
6559 behavior. Its <file>symbols</file> file therefore contains
6561 <example compact="compact">
6562 compress@Base 1:1.1.4
6563 compressBound@ZLIB_1.2.0 1:1.2.0
6565 Packages using only <tt>compress</tt> would then get a
6566 dependency on <tt>zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.4)</tt>, but packages
6567 using <tt>compressBound</tt> would get a dependency
6568 on <tt>zlib1g (>= 1:1.2.0)</tt>.
6572 One or more <var>alternative-dependency-template</var> lines
6573 may be provided. These are used in cases where some symbols
6574 in the shared library should use one dependency template
6575 while others should use a different template. The
6576 alternative dependency templates are used only if a symbol
6577 line contains the <var>id-of-dependency-template</var>
6578 field. The first alternative dependency template is
6579 numbered 1, the second 2, and so forth.<footnote>
6580 An example of where this may be needed is with a library
6581 that implements the libGL interface. All GL
6582 implementations provide the same set of base interfaces,
6583 and then may provide some additional interfaces only used
6584 by programs that require that specific GL implementation.
6585 So, for example, libgl1-mesa-glx may use the
6586 following <file>symbols</file> file:
6589 | libgl1-mesa-glx #MINVER#
6590 publicGlSymbol@Base 6.3-1
6592 implementationSpecificSymbol@Base 6.5.2-7 1
6595 Binaries or shared libraries using
6596 only <tt>publicGlSymbol</tt> would depend only
6597 on <tt>libgl1</tt> (which may be provided by multiple
6599 using <tt>implementationSpecificSymbol</tt> would get a
6600 dependency on <tt>libgl1-mesa-glx (>= 6.5.2-7)</tt>
6605 Finally, the entry for the library may contain one or more
6606 metadata fields. Currently, the only
6607 supported <var>field-name</var>
6608 is <tt>Build-Depends-Package</tt>, whose value lists
6609 the <qref id="sharedlibs-dev">library development
6610 package</qref> on which packages using this shared library
6611 declare a build dependency. If this field is
6612 present, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> uses it to ensure that
6613 the resulting binary package dependency on the shared
6614 library is at least as strict as the source package
6615 dependency on the shared library development
6617 This field should normally not be necessary, since if the
6618 behavior of any symbol has changed, the corresponding
6619 symbol <var>minimal-version</var> should have been
6620 increased. But including it makes the <tt>symbols</tt>
6621 system more robust by tightening the dependency in cases
6622 where the package using the shared library specifically
6623 requires at least a particular version of the shared
6624 library development package for some reason.
6626 For our example, the <tt>zlib1g</tt> <file>symbols</file>
6628 <example compact="compact">
6629 * Build-Depends-Package: zlib1g-dev
6634 Also see <manref name="deb-symbols" section="5">.
6638 <sect2 id="providing-symbols">
6639 <heading>Providing a <file>symbols</file> file</heading>
6642 If your package provides a shared library, you should
6643 arrange to include a <file>symbols</file> control file
6644 following the format described above in that package. You
6645 must include either a <file>symbols</file> control file or
6646 a <file>shlibs</file> control file.
6650 Normally, this is done by creating a <file>symbols</file> in
6652 named <file>debian/<var>package</var>.symbols</file>
6653 or <file>debian/symbols</file>, possibly
6654 with <file>.<var>arch</var></file> appended if the symbols
6655 information varies by architecture. This file may use the
6656 extended syntax documented in <manref name="dpkg-gensymbols"
6657 section="1">. Then, call <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn> as
6658 part of the package build process. It will
6659 create <file>symbols</file> files in the package staging
6660 area based on the binaries and libraries in the package
6661 staging area and the <file>symbols</file> files in the
6662 source package.<footnote>
6664 using <tt>debhelper</tt>, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> will
6665 take care of calling either <prgn>dpkg-gensymbols</prgn>
6666 or generating a <file>shlibs</file> file as appropriate.
6671 Packages that provide <file>symbols</file> files must keep
6672 them up-to-date to ensure correct dependencies in packages
6673 that use the shared libraries. This means updating
6674 the <file>symbols</file> file whenever a new public symbol
6675 is added, changing the <var>minimal-version</var> field
6676 whenever a symbol changes behavior or signature in a
6677 backward-compatible way (see <ref id="sharedlibs-updates">),
6678 and changing the <var>library-soname</var>
6679 and <var>main-dependency-template</var>, and probably all of
6680 the <var>minimal-version</var> fields, when the library
6681 changes <tt>SONAME</tt>. Removing a public symbol from
6682 the <file>symbols</file> file because it's no longer
6683 provided by the library normally requires changing
6684 the <tt>SONAME</tt> of the library.
6685 See <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> for more information
6686 on <tt>SONAME</tt>s.
6691 <sect1 id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
6692 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
6695 The <tt>shlibs</tt> system is a simpler alternative to
6696 the <tt>symbols</tt> system for declaring dependencies for
6697 shared libraries. It may be more appropriate for C++
6698 libraries and other cases where tracking individual symbols is
6699 too difficult. It predated the <tt>symbols</tt> system and is
6700 therefore frequently seen in older packages. It is also
6701 required for udebs, which do not support <tt>symbols</tt>.
6705 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
6706 various <file>shlibs</file> files are to be found, then how to
6707 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally
6708 the <file>shlibs</file> file format and how to create them.
6711 <sect2 id="shlibs-paths">
6712 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> files present on the
6716 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
6717 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
6718 they are read by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>. (The first
6719 one which gives the required information is used.)
6722 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
6725 This lists overrides for this package. This file
6726 should normally not be used, but may be needed
6727 temporarily in unusual situations to work around bugs
6728 in other packages, or in unusual cases where the
6729 normally declared dependency information in the
6730 installed <file>shlibs</file> file for a library
6731 cannot be used. This file overrides information
6732 obtained from any other source.
6737 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
6740 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
6741 empty. It is maintained by the local system
6747 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build
6751 These files are generated as part of the package build
6752 process and staged for inclusion as control files in
6753 the binary packages being built. They provide details
6754 of any shared libraries included in the same package.
6759 <p><file>shlibs</file> control files for packages
6760 installed on the system</p>
6763 The <file>shlibs</file> control files for all the
6764 packages currently installed on the system. These are
6766 in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file>, but
6767 packages should not rely on this and instead should
6768 use <tt>dpkg-query --control-path <var>package</var>
6769 shlibs</tt> if for some reason these files need to be
6775 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
6778 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
6779 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file>
6780 files. It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup
6781 was first introduced, but it is now normally empty.
6782 It is maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
6789 If a <file>symbols</file> file for a shared library package
6790 is available, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will always use it
6791 in preference to a <file>shlibs</file>, with the exception
6792 of <file>debian/shlibs.local</file>. The latter overrides
6793 any other <file>shlibs</file> or <file>symbols</file> files.
6798 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
6801 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
6802 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
6803 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
6804 <example compact="compact">
6805 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
6810 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
6811 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
6813 library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.2.3.4</file>.
6817 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the
6818 type of package for which the line is valid. The only type
6819 currently in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space
6820 after the type are required.
6824 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
6825 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
6826 of the soname, see below.)
6830 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the
6831 ELF <tt>SONAME</tt> attribute of the library, determined the
6832 same way that the <var>soversion</var> component of the
6833 recommended shared library package name is determined.
6834 See <ref id="sharedlibs-runtime"> for the details.
6838 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
6839 field in a binary package control file. It should give
6840 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
6841 built against the version of the library contained in the
6842 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details on the
6843 syntax, and <ref id="sharedlibs-updates"> for details on how
6844 to maintain the dependency version constraint.
6848 In our example, if the last change to the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
6849 package that could change behavior for a client of that
6850 library was in version <tt>1:1.2.3.3.dfsg-1</tt>, then
6851 the <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
6852 <example compact="compact">
6853 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.2.3.3.dfsg)
6855 This version restriction must be new enough that any binary
6856 built against the current version of the library will work
6857 with any version of the shared library that satisfies that
6862 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared
6863 library, there would also be a second line:
6864 <example compact="compact">
6865 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.2.3.3.dfsg)
6871 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
6874 To provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for a shared library
6875 binary package, create a <file>shlibs</file> file following
6876 the format described above and place it in
6877 the <file>DEBIAN</file> directory for that package during
6878 the build. It will then be included as a control file for
6879 that package<footnote>
6880 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in
6881 the <package>debhelper</package> suite does. If your
6882 package also has a udeb that provides a shared
6883 library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can automatically
6884 generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify the name
6885 of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
6890 Since <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads
6891 the <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary
6892 packages being built from this source package, all of
6893 the <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed
6894 before <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the
6903 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
6906 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
6910 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
6913 The location of all files and directories must comply with the
6914 Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS), version 2.3, with the
6915 exceptions noted below, and except where doing so would
6916 violate other terms of Debian Policy. The following
6917 exceptions to the FHS apply:
6922 The FHS requirement that architecture-independent
6923 application-specific static files be located in
6924 <file>/usr/share</file> is relaxed to a suggestion.
6926 In particular, a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file> may
6927 be used by a package (or a collection of packages) to hold a
6928 mixture of architecture-independent and
6929 architecture-dependent files. However, when a directory is
6930 entirely composed of architecture-independent files, it
6931 should be located in <file>/usr/share</file>.
6936 The optional rules related to user specific
6937 configuration files for applications are stored in
6938 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
6939 recommended that such files start with the
6940 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
6941 application needs to create more than one dot file
6942 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
6943 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
6944 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
6945 configuration files not start with the '.'
6951 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
6952 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
6957 The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and
6958 libraries, including <file>libc.so.*</file>, to be located
6959 directly under <file>/lib{,32}</file> and
6960 <file>/usr/lib{,32}</file> is amended, permitting files
6961 to instead be installed to
6962 <file>/lib/<var>triplet</var></file> and
6963 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>, where
6964 <tt><var>triplet</var></tt> is the value returned by
6965 <tt>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_MULTIARCH</tt> for the
6966 architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em>
6967 install files to any <var>triplet</var> path other
6968 than the one matching the architecture of that package;
6969 for instance, an <tt>Architecture: amd64</tt> package
6970 containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these
6971 libraries to <file>/usr/lib/i386-linux-gnu</file>.
6973 This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for
6974 use in cross-installation of library packages from other
6975 architectures, as part of the planned deployment of
6980 Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
6981 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>.
6984 The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made
6985 available in the existing location under /lib or /lib64
6986 since this is part of the ELF ABI for the architecture.
6991 The requirement that
6992 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
6993 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
6998 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
6999 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
7000 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
7001 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
7002 window manager name itself.
7007 The requirement that boot manager configuration
7008 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
7009 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
7014 The additional directory <file>/run</file> in the root
7015 file system is allowed. <file>/run</file>
7016 replaces <file>/var/run</file>, and the
7017 subdirectory <file>/run/lock</file>
7018 replaces <file>/var/lock</file>, with
7019 the <file>/var</file> directories replaced by symlinks
7020 for backwards compatibility. <file>/run</file>
7021 and <file>/run/lock</file> must follow all of the
7022 requirements in the FHS for <file>/var/run</file>
7023 and <file>/var/lock</file>, respectively, such as file
7024 naming conventions, file format requirements, or the
7025 requirement that files be cleared during the boot
7026 process. Files and directories residing
7027 in <file>/run</file> should be stored on a temporary
7031 Packages must not assume the <file>/run</file>
7032 directory exists or is usable without a dependency
7033 on <tt>initscripts (>= 2.88dsf-13.3)</tt> until the
7034 stable release of Debian supports <file>/run</file>.
7039 The <file>/sys</file> directory in the root filesystem is
7040 additionally allowed. <footnote>This directory is used as
7041 mount point to mount virtual filesystems to get access to
7042 kernel information.</footnote>
7047 On GNU/Hurd systems, the following additional
7048 directories are allowed in the root
7049 filesystem: <file>/hurd</file>
7050 and <file>/servers</file>.<footnote>
7051 These directories are used to store translators and as
7052 a set of standard names for mount points,
7061 The version of this document referred here can be
7062 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
7063 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
7064 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
7065 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
7067 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
7068 (local copy)">). The
7069 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
7071 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
7072 Specific questions about following the standard may be
7073 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
7074 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
7075 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
7081 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
7084 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
7085 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
7086 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7087 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
7091 However, the package may create empty directories below
7092 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
7093 where to place site-specific files. These are not
7094 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
7095 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
7096 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
7097 should be removed on package removal if they are
7102 Note that this applies only to
7103 directories <em>below</em> <file>/usr/local</file>,
7104 not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>. Packages must
7105 not create sub-directories in the
7106 directory <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those
7107 listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
7108 directories below them as you wish. You must not remove
7109 any of the directories listed in 4.5, even if you created
7114 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
7115 remote server, these directories must be created and
7116 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
7117 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
7118 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
7119 either of these operations fail.
7123 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
7124 contain something like
7125 <example compact="compact">
7126 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]; then
7127 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null; then
7128 if chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs; then
7129 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs || true
7134 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
7135 <example compact="compact">
7136 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
7137 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
7139 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
7140 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
7141 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
7146 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
7147 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
7148 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
7149 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
7153 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
7154 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
7155 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
7156 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
7160 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
7161 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
7162 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
7163 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
7168 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
7170 The system-wide mail directory
7171 is <file>/var/mail</file>. This directory is part of the
7172 base system and should not be owned by any particular mail
7173 agents. The use of the old
7174 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
7175 though the spool may still be physically located there.
7179 <sect1 id="fhs-run">
7180 <heading><file>/run</file> and <file>/run/lock</file></heading>
7183 The directory <file>/run</file> is cleared at boot, normally
7184 by being a mount point for a temporary file system. Packages
7185 therefore must not assume that any files or directories
7186 under <file>/run</file> other than <file>/run/lock</file>
7187 exist unless the package has arranged to create those files or
7188 directories since the last reboot. Normally, this is done by
7189 the package via an init script. See <ref id="writing-init">
7190 for more information.
7194 Packages must not include files or directories
7195 under <file>/run</file>, or under the
7196 older <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> paths.
7197 The latter paths will normally be symlinks or other
7198 redirections to <file>/run</file> for backwards compatibility.
7204 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
7207 <heading>Introduction</heading>
7209 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
7214 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
7215 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
7216 packages need to include files which are owned by these
7217 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
7218 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
7219 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
7220 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
7221 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
7222 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
7226 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
7227 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
7228 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
7232 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
7233 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
7234 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
7239 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
7241 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
7247 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
7248 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
7249 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
7250 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
7251 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
7256 Packages which need a single statically allocated
7257 uid or gid should use one of these; their
7258 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
7266 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
7267 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
7268 this user or group allocated dynamically and
7269 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
7270 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
7271 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
7272 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
7273 id based on the ranges specified in
7274 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
7278 <tag>1000-59999:</tag>
7281 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
7282 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
7283 user accounts in this range, though
7284 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
7289 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
7292 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
7293 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
7294 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
7295 created on users' systems on demand.
7299 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
7300 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
7301 packages should check for and create the accounts in
7302 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
7303 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
7304 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
7305 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
7306 them in the allocation, to give them room to
7311 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
7319 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
7320 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
7327 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
7328 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
7337 <sect id="sysvinit">
7338 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
7340 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
7341 <heading>Introduction</heading>
7344 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
7345 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
7346 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
7347 name="init" section="8">).
7351 There are at least two different, yet functionally
7352 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
7353 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
7354 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
7355 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
7356 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
7357 maintainer scripts must be performed using
7358 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
7359 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
7360 on the implementation details of the other method,
7361 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
7362 to the documentation of that package.
7366 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
7367 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
7368 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
7369 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
7370 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
7371 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
7376 The names of the links all have the form
7377 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
7378 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
7379 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
7380 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
7381 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
7385 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
7386 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
7387 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
7388 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
7389 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
7390 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
7391 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
7392 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
7393 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
7397 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
7398 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
7399 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
7400 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
7401 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
7402 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
7403 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
7408 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
7409 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
7410 have their scripts run first. For example, the
7411 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
7412 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
7413 must be started before another. For example, the name
7414 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
7415 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
7416 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
7417 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
7418 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
7420 <example compact="compact">
7427 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
7428 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
7429 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
7430 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
7431 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
7435 <sect1 id="writing-init">
7436 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
7439 Packages that include daemons for system services should
7440 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
7441 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
7442 These scripts should be named
7443 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
7444 accept one argument, saying what to do:
7447 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
7448 <item>start the service,</item>
7450 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
7451 <item>stop the service,</item>
7453 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
7454 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
7455 otherwise start the service</item>
7457 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
7458 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
7459 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
7462 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
7463 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
7464 service supports this, otherwise restart the
7468 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
7469 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
7470 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
7475 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
7476 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
7477 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
7478 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
7479 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
7480 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
7481 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
7486 Be careful of using <tt>set -e</tt> in <file>init.d</file>
7487 scripts. Writing correct <file>init.d</file> scripts requires
7488 accepting various error exit statuses when daemons are already
7489 running or already stopped without aborting
7490 the <file>init.d</file> script, and common <file>init.d</file>
7491 function libraries are not safe to call with <tt>set -e</tt>
7493 <tt>/lib/lsb/init-functions</tt>, which assists in writing
7494 LSB-compliant init scripts, may fail if <tt>set -e</tt> is
7495 in effect and echoing status messages to the console fails,
7497 </footnote>. For <tt>init.d</tt> scripts, it's often easier
7498 to not use <tt>set -e</tt> and instead check the result of
7499 each command separately.
7503 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
7504 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
7505 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
7506 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
7511 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
7512 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
7513 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
7514 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
7515 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
7516 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
7517 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
7518 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
7519 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
7520 some special command line options when starting a service,
7521 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
7526 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
7527 configuration files remain but the package has been
7528 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
7529 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7530 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
7531 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
7532 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
7533 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
7534 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
7535 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
7537 <example compact="compact">
7538 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
7543 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
7544 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
7545 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
7546 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
7547 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
7548 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
7549 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
7550 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
7551 values should not be placed directly in the script.
7552 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
7553 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
7554 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
7555 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
7556 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
7557 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
7558 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
7559 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
7564 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
7565 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
7566 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
7567 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
7568 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
7569 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
7570 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
7571 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
7575 Files and directories under <file>/run</file>, including ones
7576 referred to via the compatibility paths <file>/var/run</file>
7577 and <file>/var/lock</file>, are normally stored on a temporary
7578 filesystem and are normally not persistent across a reboot.
7579 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this correctly.
7580 This will typically mean creating any required subdirectories
7581 dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script is run.
7582 See <ref id="fhs-run"> for more information.
7587 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
7590 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
7591 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
7592 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
7593 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
7594 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
7598 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
7599 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
7600 be done only by packages providing the initscript
7601 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
7602 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
7606 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
7609 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
7610 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
7611 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
7612 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
7613 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
7614 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
7618 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
7619 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
7620 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
7621 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
7622 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
7623 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
7624 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
7625 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
7630 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
7631 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
7632 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
7633 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
7634 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
7635 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
7636 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
7637 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
7638 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
7643 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
7644 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
7645 <example compact="compact">
7646 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
7648 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
7649 <example compact="compact">
7650 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
7651 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
7653 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
7654 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
7655 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
7656 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
7660 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
7661 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
7662 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
7663 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
7664 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
7665 help you choose a number.
7669 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
7670 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
7676 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
7678 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
7679 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
7680 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
7681 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
7682 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
7683 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
7687 The package maintainer scripts must use
7688 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
7689 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
7690 calling them directly.
7694 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
7695 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
7696 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
7697 to start or restart a service out of its intended
7702 Most packages will simply need to change:
7703 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/<package>
7704 <action></example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
7705 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
7706 <example compact="compact">
7707 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
7708 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> <action>
7710 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> <action>
7716 A package should register its initscript services using
7717 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
7718 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
7719 unregistered services may fail.
7723 For more information about using
7724 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
7725 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
7731 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
7734 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
7735 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
7736 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
7737 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
7738 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
7739 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
7744 <heading>Example</heading>
7747 An example on which you can base your
7748 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
7749 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
7756 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
7759 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
7760 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
7761 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
7762 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
7763 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
7764 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
7765 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
7769 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
7770 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
7776 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
7777 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
7778 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
7782 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
7783 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
7784 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
7785 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
7786 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
7790 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
7791 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
7792 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
7793 <example compact="compact">
7794 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
7796 the message should say
7797 <example compact="compact">
7798 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
7805 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
7806 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
7812 <p>When daemons are started</p>
7815 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
7816 should look like this (a single line, no leading
7818 <example compact="compact">
7819 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
7821 The <var>description</var> should describe the
7822 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
7823 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
7824 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
7829 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
7831 <example compact="compact">
7832 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
7837 This can be achieved by saying
7838 <example compact="compact">
7839 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
7840 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
7843 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
7844 start, the output should look like this:
7845 <example compact="compact">
7846 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
7847 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
7848 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
7849 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
7852 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
7853 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
7854 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
7855 in the example above the system administrators can
7856 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
7857 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
7863 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
7866 If you have to set up different system parameters
7867 during the system boot, you should use this format:
7868 <example compact="compact">
7869 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
7874 You can use a statement such as the following to get
7876 <example compact="compact">
7877 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
7882 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) <!-- " --> is used
7883 for the left and right quotation marks. A grave accent
7884 (<tt>`</tt>) is not a quote character; neither is an
7885 apostrophe (<tt>'</tt>).
7890 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
7893 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
7894 message identical to the startup message, except that
7895 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
7896 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
7900 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
7902 <example compact="compact">
7903 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
7909 <p>When something is executed</p>
7912 There are several examples where you have to run a
7913 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
7914 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
7915 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
7916 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
7918 <example compact="compact">
7919 Doing something very useful...done.
7921 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
7922 the job has been completed, so that the user is
7923 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
7925 <example compact="compact">
7926 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
7935 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
7938 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
7939 files you should use the following format:
7940 <example compact="compact">
7941 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
7943 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
7944 daemon starting message.
7951 <sect id="cron-jobs">
7952 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
7955 Packages must not modify the configuration file
7956 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
7957 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.
7961 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed via
7962 cron, it should place a file named as specified
7963 in <ref id="cron-files"> into one or more of the following
7965 <example compact="compact">
7971 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
7972 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
7973 respectively. The exact times are listed in
7974 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.
7978 All files installed in any of these directories must be
7979 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
7980 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
7981 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
7985 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
7986 at a specific time, the package should install a file in
7987 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> with a name as specified
7988 in <ref id="cron-files">. This file uses the same syntax
7989 as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed
7990 by <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
7991 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
7992 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
7993 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
7994 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
7999 Unlike <file>crontab</file> files described in the IEEE Std
8000 1003.1-2008 (POSIX.1) available from
8001 <url id="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/"
8002 name="The Open Group">, the files in
8003 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> and the file
8004 <file>/etc/crontab</file> have seven fields; namely:
8006 <item>Minute [0,59]</item>
8007 <item>Hour [0,23]</item>
8008 <item>Day of the month [1,31]</item>
8009 <item>Month of the year [1,12]</item>
8010 <item>Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)</item>
8011 <item>Username</item>
8012 <item>Command to be run</item>
8014 Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers
8015 separated with a hyphen. The specified range is inclusive.
8016 Lists are allowed. A list is a set of numbers (or ranges)
8017 separated by commas. Step values can be used in conjunction
8022 The scripts or <tt>crontab</tt> entries in these directories should
8023 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
8024 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
8025 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
8026 are kept on the system in this situation.
8030 Any <tt>cron</tt> daemon must provide
8031 <file>/usr/bin/crontab</file> and support normal
8032 <tt>crontab</tt> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
8033 must also support names for days and months, ranges, and
8034 step values. It has to support <file>/etc/crontab</file>,
8035 and correctly execute the scripts in
8036 <file>/etc/cron.d</file>. The daemon must also correctly
8038 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>.
8041 <sect1 id="cron-files">
8042 <heading>Cron job file names</heading>
8045 The file name of a cron job file should normally match the
8046 name of the package from which it comes.
8050 If a package supplies multiple cron job files files in the
8051 same directory, the file names should all start with the name
8052 of the package (possibly modified as described below) followed
8053 by a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>) and a suitable suffix.
8057 A cron job file name must not include any period or plus
8058 characters (<tt>.</tt> or <tt>+</tt>) characters as this will
8059 cause cron to ignore the file. Underscores (<tt>_</tt>)
8060 should be used instead of <tt>.</tt> and <tt>+</tt>
8067 <heading>Menus</heading>
8070 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
8071 interface between packages providing applications and
8072 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
8073 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
8077 All packages that provide applications that need not be
8078 passed any special command line arguments for normal
8079 operation should register a menu entry for those
8080 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
8081 will automatically get menu entries in their window
8082 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
8086 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
8090 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
8091 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
8092 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8093 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
8094 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
8098 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
8099 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
8100 package for information about how to register your
8106 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
8109 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
8110 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
8111 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
8112 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
8117 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
8118 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
8119 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
8123 Packages which provide programs to view/show/play, compose, edit or
8124 print MIME types should register them as such by placing a file in
8125 <manref name="mailcap" section="5"> format (RFC 1524) in the directory
8126 <file>/usr/lib/mime/packages/</file>. The file name should be the
8127 binary package's name.
8131 The <package>mime-support</package> package provides the
8132 <prgn>update-mime</prgn> program, which integrates these
8133 registrations in the <file>/etc/mailcap</file> file, using dpkg
8135 Creating, modifying or removing a file in
8136 <file>/usr/lib/mime/packages/</file> using maintainer scripts will
8137 not activate the trigger. In that case, it can be done by calling
8138 <tt>dpkg-trigger --no-await /usr/lib/mime/packages</tt> from
8139 the maintainer script after creating, modifying, or removing
8142 Packages using this facility <em>should not</em> depend on,
8143 recommend, or suggest <prgn>mime-support</prgn>.
8148 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
8151 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
8152 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
8153 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
8154 comply with the following guidelines.
8158 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
8161 <tag><tt><--</tt></tag>
8162 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
8164 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
8165 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
8167 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
8168 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
8171 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
8172 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
8173 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
8178 The following list explains how the different programs
8179 should be set up to achieve this:
8185 <tt><--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
8189 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
8193 X translations are set up to make
8194 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
8195 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
8196 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
8197 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
8198 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
8199 using the application defaults, so that the
8200 translation resources used correspond to the
8201 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
8205 The Linux console is configured to make
8206 <tt><--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
8207 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
8211 X applications are configured so that <tt><</tt>
8212 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
8213 applications already work like this.
8217 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
8221 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
8222 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
8223 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
8227 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
8228 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
8229 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
8230 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
8231 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
8235 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
8236 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
8237 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
8238 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
8246 This will solve the problem except for the following
8253 Some terminals have a <tt><--</tt> key that cannot
8254 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
8255 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
8256 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
8257 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
8258 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
8259 available) can be used instead.
8263 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
8264 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
8265 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
8266 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
8267 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
8268 correctly, things can be made to work by using
8269 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
8273 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
8274 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
8275 <tt><--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
8276 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
8277 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
8278 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
8279 using their resources when things are the other way
8280 around. On displays configured like this
8281 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt><--</tt>
8286 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
8287 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
8288 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
8289 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
8290 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
8291 <tt><--</tt> will.
8298 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
8301 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
8302 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
8303 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
8304 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
8305 supported by all shells.)
8309 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
8310 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
8311 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
8312 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
8313 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
8314 available), the program must be replaced by a small
8315 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
8316 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
8320 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
8322 <example compact="compact">
8324 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
8326 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
8331 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
8332 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
8333 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
8338 <sect id="doc-base">
8339 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
8342 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
8343 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
8344 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
8345 package that provides online documentation (other than just
8346 manual pages) to register these documents with
8347 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
8348 <package>doc-base</package> control file in
8349 <file>/usr/share/doc-base/</file>.
8352 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
8353 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
8358 <sect id="alternateinit">
8359 <heading>Alternate init systems</heading>
8361 A number of other init systems are available now in Debian that
8362 can be used in place of <package>sysvinit</package>. Alternative
8363 init implementations must support running SysV init scripts as
8364 described at <ref id="sysvinit"> for compatibility.
8367 Packages may integrate with these replacement init systems by
8368 providing implementation-specific configuration information about
8369 how and when to start a service or in what order to run certain
8370 tasks at boot time. However, any package integrating with other
8371 init systems must also be backwards-compatible with
8372 <package>sysvinit</package> by providing a SysV-style init script
8373 with the same name as and equivalent functionality to any
8374 init-specific job, as this is the only start-up configuration
8375 method guaranteed to be supported by all init implementations. An
8376 exception to this rule is scripts or jobs provided by the init
8377 implementation itself; such jobs may be required for an
8378 implementation-specific equivalent of the <file>/etc/rcS.d/</file>
8379 scripts and may not have a one-to-one correspondence with the init
8382 <sect1 id="upstart">
8383 <heading>Event-based boot with upstart</heading>
8386 Packages may integrate with the <prgn>upstart</prgn> event-based
8387 boot system by installing job files in the
8388 <file>/etc/init</file> directory. SysV init scripts for which
8389 an equivalent upstart job is available must query the output of
8390 the command <prgn>initctl version</prgn> for the string
8391 <tt>upstart</tt> and avoid running in favor of the native
8392 upstart job, using a test such as this:
8393 <example compact="compact">
8394 if [ "$1" = start ] && which initctl >/dev/null && initctl version | grep -q upstart
8401 Because packages shipping upstart jobs may be installed on
8402 systems that are not using upstart, maintainer scripts must
8403 still use the common <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
8404 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> interfaces for configuring runlevels
8405 and for starting and stopping services. These maintainer
8406 scripts must not call the upstart <prgn>start</prgn>,
8407 <prgn>restart</prgn>, <prgn>reload</prgn>, or <prgn>stop</prgn>
8408 interfaces directly. Instead, implementations of
8409 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> must detect when upstart is running and
8410 when an upstart job with the same name as an init script is
8411 present, and perform the requested action using the upstart job
8412 instead of the init script.
8415 Dependency-based boot managers for SysV init scripts, such as
8416 <prgn>startpar</prgn>, may avoid running a given init script
8417 entirely when an equivalent upstart job is present, to avoid
8418 unnecessary forking of no-op init scripts. In this case, the
8419 boot manager should integrate with upstart to detect when the
8420 upstart job in question is started or stopped to know when the
8421 dependency has been satisfied.
8430 <heading>Files</heading>
8432 <sect id="binaries">
8433 <heading>Binaries</heading>
8436 Two different packages must not install programs with
8437 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
8438 case of two programs having the same functionality but
8439 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
8440 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
8441 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
8442 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
8443 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
8444 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
8445 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
8446 programs must be renamed.
8450 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
8451 created should include debugging information, as well as
8452 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
8453 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
8454 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
8455 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
8456 this means the following compilation parameters should be
8458 <example compact="compact">
8460 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
8462 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
8467 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
8468 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
8469 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
8470 the binaries after they have been copied into
8471 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
8476 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
8477 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
8478 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
8479 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
8480 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
8481 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
8482 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
8486 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
8487 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
8488 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
8489 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
8490 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
8491 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
8492 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
8493 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
8494 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
8500 <sect id="libraries">
8501 <heading>Libraries</heading>
8504 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
8505 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
8506 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
8507 the supported architectures<footnote>
8509 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
8510 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
8511 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
8512 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
8513 permitted in a shared library.
8516 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
8517 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
8518 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
8519 the few architectures where non position independent code is
8522 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
8523 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
8524 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
8525 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
8526 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
8527 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
8528 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
8530 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
8531 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
8532 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
8533 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
8538 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
8539 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
8540 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
8541 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
8542 should be discussed on the mailing list
8543 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
8544 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
8545 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
8547 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
8548 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
8549 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
8550 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
8551 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
8552 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
8553 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
8554 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
8555 distilling various libraries into a common shared
8556 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
8562 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
8563 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
8564 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
8569 Libraries should be built with threading support and to be
8570 thread-safe if the library supports this.
8574 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
8575 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
8576 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
8577 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-symbols">symbols</qref>
8578 and <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
8579 systems and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
8580 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
8581 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
8582 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
8583 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
8588 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
8589 <example compact="compact">
8590 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
8592 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
8593 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
8594 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
8595 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
8596 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
8598 You might also want to use the options
8599 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
8600 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
8601 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
8607 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
8608 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
8609 building a separate package to support debugging.
8613 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
8614 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
8615 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
8616 should be installed in subdirectories of the
8617 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
8618 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
8619 they must not be installed executable and should be
8621 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
8622 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
8623 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
8628 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create and install
8629 their shared libraries install a file containing additional
8630 metadata (ending in <file>.la</file>) alongside the library.
8631 For public libraries intended for use by other packages, these
8632 files normally should not be included in the Debian package,
8633 since the information they include is not necessary to link with
8634 the shared library on Debian and can add unnecessary additional
8635 dependencies to other programs or libraries.<footnote>
8636 These files store, among other things, all libraries on which
8637 that shared library depends. Unfortunately, if
8638 the <file>.la</file> file is present and contains that
8639 dependency information, using <prgn>libtool</prgn> when
8640 linking against that library will cause the resulting program
8641 or library to be linked against those dependencies as well,
8642 even if this is unnecessary. This can create unneeded
8643 dependencies on shared library packages that would otherwise
8644 be hidden behind the library ABI, and can make library
8645 transitions to new SONAMEs unnecessarily complicated and
8646 difficult to manage.
8648 If the <file>.la</file> file is required for that library (if,
8649 for instance, it's loaded via <tt>libltdl</tt> in a way that
8650 requires that meta-information), the <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
8651 setting in the <file>.la</file> file should normally be set to
8652 the empty string. If the shared library development package has
8653 historically included the <file>.la</file>, it must be retained
8654 in the development package (with <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
8655 emptied) until all libraries that depend on it have removed or
8656 emptied <tt>dependency_libs</tt> in their <file>.la</file>
8657 files to prevent linking with those other libraries
8658 using <prgn>libtool</prgn> from failing.
8662 If the <file>.la</file> must be included, it should be included
8663 in the development (<tt>-dev</tt>) package, unless the library
8664 will be loaded by <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s <tt>libltdl</tt>
8665 library. If it is intended for use with <tt>libltdl</tt>,
8666 the <file>.la</file> files must go in the run-time library
8671 These requirements for handling of <file>.la</file> files do not
8672 apply to loadable modules or libraries not installed in
8673 directories searched by default by the dynamic linker. Packages
8674 installing loadable modules will frequently need to install
8675 the <file>.la</file> files alongside the modules so that they
8676 can be loaded by <tt>libltdl</tt>. <tt>dependency_libs</tt>
8677 does not need to be modified for libraries or modules that are
8678 not installed in directories searched by the dynamic linker by
8679 default and not intended for use by other packages.
8683 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
8684 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
8685 users will not be able to run your binaries
8686 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
8687 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
8694 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
8696 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
8702 <heading>Scripts</heading>
8705 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
8706 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
8707 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
8712 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
8713 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
8717 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
8718 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
8719 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
8720 language currently used to implement it.
8723 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>) other than
8724 <file>init.d</file> scripts should almost certainly start
8725 with <tt>set -e</tt> so that errors are detected.
8726 <file>init.d</file> scripts are something of a special case, due
8727 to how frequently they need to call commands that are allowed to
8728 fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status of
8729 commands directly. See <ref id="writing-init"> for more
8730 information about writing <file>init.d</file> scripts.
8733 Every script should use <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status
8734 of <em>every</em> command.
8737 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
8738 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
8739 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
8740 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
8741 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
8742 name="The Open Group"> after free
8743 registration.</footnote>
8744 plus the following additional features not mandated by
8746 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
8747 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
8748 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
8751 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
8752 must not generate a newline.</item>
8753 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
8754 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
8756 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
8757 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
8758 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
8759 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
8760 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
8761 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
8765 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
8768 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
8771 <item>The XSI extension to <prgn>kill</prgn> allowing <tt>kill
8772 -<var>signal</var></tt>, where <var>signal</var> is either
8773 the name of a signal or one of the numeric signals listed in
8774 the XSI extension (0, 1, 2, 3, 6, 9, 14, and 15), must be
8775 supported if <prgn>kill</prgn> is implemented as a shell
8778 <item>The XSI extension to <prgn>trap</prgn> allowing numeric
8779 signals must be supported. In addition to the signal
8780 numbers listed in the extension, which are the same as for
8781 <prgn>kill</prgn> above, 13 (SIGPIPE) must be allowed.
8784 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
8785 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
8786 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
8787 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
8788 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
8789 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
8793 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
8794 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
8795 as its interpreter. Checking your script
8796 with <prgn>checkbashisms</prgn> from
8797 the <package>devscripts</package> package or running your script
8798 with an alternate shell such as <prgn>posh</prgn> may help
8799 uncover violations of the above requirements. If in doubt
8800 whether a script complies with these requirements,
8801 use <file>/bin/bash</file>.
8805 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
8806 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
8807 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
8811 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
8812 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
8813 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
8814 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
8815 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
8816 then you must make sure that they start with
8817 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
8818 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
8822 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
8823 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
8824 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
8825 name already exists.
8829 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
8830 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
8837 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
8840 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory should
8841 be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one top-level
8842 directory to or into another should be absolute. (A top-level
8843 directory is a sub-directory of the root
8844 directory <file>/</file>.) For example, a symbolic link
8845 from <file>/usr/lib/foo</file> to <file>/usr/share/bar</file>
8846 should be relative (<file>../share/bar</file>), but a symbolic
8847 link from <file>/var/run</file> to <file>/run</file> should be
8849 This is necessary to allow top-level directories to be
8850 symlinks. If linking <file>/var/run</file>
8851 to <file>/run</file> were done with the relative symbolic
8852 link <file>../run</file>, but <file>/var</file> were a
8853 symbolic link to <file>/srv/disk1</file>, the symbolic link
8854 would point to <file>/srv/run</file> rather than the intended
8860 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
8861 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
8866 Note that when creating a relative link using
8867 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
8868 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
8869 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
8870 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
8871 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
8872 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
8873 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
8878 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
8879 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
8880 <example compact="compact">
8881 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
8882 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
8883 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
8884 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
8889 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file (in the sense
8890 that it is meant to be uncompressed with <prgn>unzip</prgn>
8891 or <prgn>zless</prgn> etc.) should always
8892 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
8893 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
8894 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
8895 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
8900 <heading>Device files</heading>
8903 Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the
8908 If a package needs any special device files that are not
8909 included in the base system, it must call
8910 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
8911 after notifying the user<footnote>
8912 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
8913 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
8918 Packages must not remove any device files in the
8919 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
8920 system administrator.
8924 Debian uses the serial devices
8925 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
8926 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
8927 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
8931 Named pipes needed by the package must be created in
8932 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script<footnote>
8933 It's better to use <prgn>mkfifo</prgn> rather
8934 than <prgn>mknod</prgn> to create named pipes so that
8935 automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
8936 files with <prgn>mknod</prgn> won't have false positives.
8937 </footnote> and removed in
8938 the <prgn>prerm</prgn> or <prgn>postrm</prgn> script as
8943 <sect id="config-files">
8944 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
8947 <heading>Definitions</heading>
8951 <tag>configuration file</tag>
8953 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
8954 provides site- or host-specific information, or
8955 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
8956 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
8957 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
8958 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
8959 more useful site-specific behavior.
8962 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
8964 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
8965 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8966 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
8972 The distinction between these two is important; they are
8973 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
8974 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
8975 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
8979 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
8980 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
8981 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
8982 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
8983 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
8984 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
8985 file and should be treated as such.
8990 <heading>Location</heading>
8993 Any configuration files created or used by your package
8994 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
8995 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
8996 named after your package.
9000 If your package creates or uses configuration files
9001 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
9002 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
9003 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
9004 from the location that the package requires.
9009 <heading>Behavior</heading>
9012 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
9014 <list compact="compact">
9016 local changes must be preserved during a package
9020 configuration files must be preserved when the
9021 package is removed, and only deleted when the
9025 Obsolete configuration files without local changes should be
9026 removed by the package during upgrade.<footnote>
9027 The <prgn>dpkg-maintscript-helper</prgn> tool, available from the
9028 <package>dpkg</package> package, can help for this task.</footnote>
9032 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
9033 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
9034 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
9035 version that will work for most installations, although
9036 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
9037 implies that the default version will be part of the
9038 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
9039 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
9044 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
9045 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
9046 conffiles.<footnote>
9047 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
9048 The first is that some editors break the link while
9049 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
9050 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
9051 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
9052 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
9057 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
9058 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
9059 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
9060 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
9061 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
9062 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
9063 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
9064 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
9065 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
9066 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
9067 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
9068 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
9069 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
9070 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
9071 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
9072 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
9073 otherwise be good citizens.
9077 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
9078 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
9079 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
9080 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
9081 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
9082 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
9086 A common practice is to create a script called
9087 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
9088 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
9089 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
9090 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
9091 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
9092 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
9093 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
9094 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
9095 be symbolic links to them from
9096 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
9097 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
9098 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
9099 configuration files).
9103 These two styles of configuration file handling must
9104 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
9105 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
9106 every time the package is upgraded.
9111 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
9114 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
9115 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
9116 time, one of these packages must be defined as
9117 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
9118 the package which handles that file as a configuration
9119 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
9120 depend on the owning package if they require the
9121 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
9122 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
9123 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
9127 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
9128 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
9129 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
9130 file, then the following should be done:
9131 <enumlist compact="compact">
9133 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
9134 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
9135 scripts as described in the previous section.
9138 The owning package should also provide a program
9139 that the other packages may use to modify the
9143 The related packages must use the provided program
9144 to make any desired modifications to the
9145 configuration file. They should either depend on
9146 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
9147 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
9148 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
9149 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
9150 configuration file may not even be present in the
9157 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
9158 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
9159 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
9160 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
9164 If the configuration file cannot be shared as described above,
9165 the packages must be marked as conflicting with each other.
9166 Two packages that specify the same file as
9167 a <tt>conffile</tt> must conflict. This is an instance of the
9168 general rule about not sharing files. Neither alternatives
9169 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case; in
9170 particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
9171 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.
9175 When two packages both declare the same <tt>conffile</tt>, they
9176 may see left-over configuration files from each other even
9177 though they conflict with each other. If a user removes
9178 (without purging) one of the packages and installs the other,
9179 the new package will take over the <tt>conffile</tt> from the
9180 old package. If the file was modified by the user, it will be
9181 treated the same as any other locally
9182 modified <tt>conffile</tt> during an upgrade.
9186 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
9187 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
9193 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
9196 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
9197 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
9198 No other program should reference the files in
9199 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
9203 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
9204 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
9205 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
9210 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
9211 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
9212 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
9216 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
9217 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
9218 default behavior as possible.
9222 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
9223 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
9224 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
9225 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
9226 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
9227 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
9228 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
9232 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
9233 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
9234 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
9235 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
9236 existing users when a package is installed.
9242 <heading>Log files</heading>
9244 Log files should usually be named
9245 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
9246 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
9247 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
9248 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
9249 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
9254 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't grow
9255 indefinitely. The best way to do this is to install a log
9256 rotation configuration file in the
9257 directory <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>, normally
9258 named <file>/etc/logrotate.d/<var>package</var></file>, and use
9259 the facilities provided by <prgn>logrotate</prgn>.
9262 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
9263 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
9264 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
9265 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
9266 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
9267 by automatically installing a system which can be used
9268 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
9272 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
9273 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
9274 It has both a configuration file
9275 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
9276 packages can drop their individual log rotation
9277 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
9280 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
9281 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
9283 <example compact="compact">
9284 /var/log/foo/*.log {
9290 start-stop-daemon -K -p /var/run/foo.pid -s HUP -x /usr/sbin/foo -q
9294 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
9295 compressed generations, and tells the daemon to reopen its log
9296 files after the log rotation. It skips this log rotation
9297 (via <tt>missingok</tt>) if no such log file is present, which
9298 avoids errors if the package is removed but not purged.
9302 Log files should be removed when the package is
9303 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
9304 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
9305 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
9306 id="removedetails">).
9310 <sect id="permissions-owners">
9311 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
9314 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
9315 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
9316 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
9317 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
9318 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
9319 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
9323 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
9324 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
9325 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
9329 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
9330 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
9331 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
9332 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
9335 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
9336 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
9337 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
9338 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
9339 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
9340 directories already on the system does not change on
9341 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
9342 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
9343 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
9344 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
9345 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
9346 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
9352 Control information files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>
9353 and either mode 644 (for most files) or mode 755 (for
9354 executables such as <qref id="maintscripts">maintainer
9359 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
9360 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
9361 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
9362 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
9363 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
9364 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
9365 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
9366 on non-set-id executables.
9370 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
9371 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
9372 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
9373 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
9374 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
9375 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
9380 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
9381 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
9382 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
9383 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
9384 described below.<footnote>
9385 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
9386 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
9387 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
9388 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
9389 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
9392 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
9393 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
9394 executables executable only by that group.
9398 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
9399 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
9400 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
9401 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
9402 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
9403 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
9404 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
9407 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
9408 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
9409 and must not release the package until you have been
9410 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
9411 either make the package depend on a version of the
9412 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
9413 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
9414 your package to create the user or group itself with the
9415 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
9416 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
9417 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
9418 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
9419 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
9423 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
9424 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
9425 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
9426 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
9427 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
9428 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
9429 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
9430 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
9431 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
9432 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
9433 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
9434 preferred if it is possible).
9438 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
9439 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
9440 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
9441 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
9442 changing your mind later will cause problems.
9445 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
9447 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
9448 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
9452 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
9453 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
9454 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
9455 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
9456 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
9457 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
9458 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
9459 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
9460 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
9461 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
9462 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
9463 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
9464 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
9465 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
9466 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
9467 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
9468 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
9469 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
9470 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
9474 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
9475 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
9476 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
9477 one type of situation, though, where calls to
9478 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
9479 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
9480 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
9481 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
9482 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
9483 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
9485 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
9487 # only do something when no setting exists
9488 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
9490 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
9491 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
9492 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
9497 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
9500 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
9502 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
9504 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
9512 <sect id="filenames">
9513 <heading>File names</heading>
9516 The name of the files installed by binary packages in the system PATH
9517 (namely <tt>/bin</tt>, <tt>/sbin</tt>, <tt>/usr/bin</tt>,
9518 <tt>/usr/sbin</tt> and <tt>/usr/games</tt>) must be encoded in
9523 The name of the files and directories installed by binary packages
9524 outside the system PATH must be encoded in UTF-8 and should be
9525 restricted to ASCII when it is possible to do so.
9531 <chapt id="customized-programs">
9532 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
9534 <sect id="arch-spec">
9535 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
9538 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
9539 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the strings
9540 provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The strings are in
9541 the format <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS
9542 part is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.
9546 Note that we don't want to use
9547 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
9548 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
9549 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
9550 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
9551 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
9552 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
9555 <sect1 id="arch-wildcard-spec">
9556 <heading>Architecture wildcards</heading>
9559 A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture
9560 wildcards are in the format <tt>any</tt> (which matches every
9561 architecture), <tt><var>os</var></tt>-any, or
9562 any-<tt><var>cpu</var></tt>. <footnote>
9563 Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets
9564 and the Debian arches into Debian arch triplets (which are
9565 kind of inverted GNU triplets), with the first component of
9566 the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use, and then
9567 does matching against those triplets. However, such
9568 triplets are an internal implementation detail that should
9569 not be used by packages directly. The libc and ABI portion
9570 is handled internally by the package system based on
9571 the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
9578 <heading>Daemons</heading>
9581 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
9582 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
9583 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
9588 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
9589 maintainer should get in contact with the
9590 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
9591 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
9596 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
9597 modified by the package's scripts except via the
9598 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
9599 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
9600 for details on how to add entries.
9604 If a package wants to install an example entry into
9605 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
9606 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
9607 treated as "commented out by user" by the
9608 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
9609 activated during package updates.
9614 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
9618 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
9619 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
9620 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
9621 is required for other functionality.
9625 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
9626 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
9627 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
9628 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
9633 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
9636 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
9637 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
9638 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
9639 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
9640 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
9645 In addition, every program should choose a good default
9646 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
9651 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
9652 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
9653 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
9654 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
9655 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
9659 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9660 "alternatives" mechanism. Every package providing an editor or
9661 pager must call the <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to
9662 register as an alternative for <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
9663 or <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> as appropriate. The alternative
9664 should have a slave alternative
9665 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/editor.1.gz</file>
9666 or <file>/usr/share/man/man1/pager.1.gz</file> pointing to the
9667 corresponding manual page.
9671 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
9672 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
9673 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
9674 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
9675 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
9676 <package>sensible-utils</package> package that check the EDITOR
9677 and PAGER variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall
9678 back to <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
9679 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the variable is not set.
9683 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
9684 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
9685 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
9686 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
9690 It is not required for a package to depend on
9691 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
9692 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
9693 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
9699 <sect id="web-appl">
9700 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
9703 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
9704 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
9711 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
9713 <example compact="compact">
9716 or a subdirectory of that directory, and the script
9717 <example compact="compact">
9718 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/.../<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
9720 should be referred to as
9721 <example compact="compact">
9722 http://localhost/cgi-bin/.../<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
9731 <p>Access to images</p>
9733 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
9734 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
9735 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
9738 http://localhost/images/<package>/<filename>
9745 <p>Web Document Root</p>
9748 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
9749 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
9750 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
9751 documents and register the Web Application via the
9752 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
9753 web document root is unavoidable then use
9754 <example compact="compact">
9757 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
9758 link to the location where the system administrator
9759 has put the real document root.
9762 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
9764 All web servers should provide the virtual package
9765 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
9766 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
9769 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
9770 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
9771 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
9779 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
9780 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
9783 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
9784 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
9785 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
9786 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
9787 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
9792 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
9793 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
9794 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
9795 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
9796 access to the mail spool should be via the
9797 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
9798 base system and not part of the MTA package.
9802 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
9803 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
9804 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
9805 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
9806 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
9807 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
9808 a non blocking way<footnote>
9809 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
9810 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
9811 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
9812 time, and start over locking again.
9813 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
9814 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
9815 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
9816 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (>>1.01)</tt>
9817 to use these functions.
9818 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
9822 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
9823 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
9824 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
9825 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
9826 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
9827 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
9828 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
9829 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
9830 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
9831 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
9832 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
9833 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
9834 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
9835 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
9836 permits either scheme.
9837 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
9838 different permission scheme; packages should not make
9839 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
9840 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
9841 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
9842 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
9846 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
9847 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
9848 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
9849 using this privilege).</p>
9852 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
9853 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
9854 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
9855 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
9856 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
9857 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
9858 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
9859 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
9860 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
9861 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
9862 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control fields.
9866 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
9867 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
9868 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
9871 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
9872 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
9873 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
9874 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
9878 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
9879 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
9880 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
9881 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
9882 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
9883 (followed by a newline).
9887 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
9888 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
9889 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
9890 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
9891 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
9892 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
9893 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
9894 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
9895 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
9896 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
9897 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
9898 <example compact="compact">
9899 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
9900 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
9901 news and mail messages. The default is
9902 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
9903 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
9905 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
9911 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
9914 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
9915 servers and clients should be located under
9916 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
9919 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
9920 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
9924 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
9926 A string which should appear as the
9927 organization header for all messages posted
9928 by NNTP clients on the machine
9931 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
9933 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
9934 server, or localhost if the local machine is
9939 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
9946 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
9949 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
9952 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
9953 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
9954 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
9955 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
9956 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
9957 on which it depends, it is required that either the
9958 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
9959 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
9960 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
9966 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
9969 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
9970 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
9971 hardware should declare in their <tt>Provides</tt> control
9972 field that they provide the virtual
9973 package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
9974 This implements current practice, and provides an
9975 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
9976 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
9977 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
9978 directly with the display and input hardware or via
9979 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
9980 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
9981 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
9987 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
9990 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
9991 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare in
9992 their <tt>Provides</tt> control field that they provide the
9993 virtual package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should
9994 also register themselves as an alternative for
9995 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
9996 20. That alternative should have a slave alternative
9997 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/x-terminal-emulator.1.gz</file>
9998 pointing to the corresponding manual page.
10002 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
10003 <list compact="compact">
10005 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
10006 compatible terminal.
10010 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
10011 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
10012 terminal window<footnote>
10013 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
10014 a new top-level X window directly parented by
10015 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
10016 emulator application were so coded, be a new
10017 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
10019 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
10020 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
10021 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
10022 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
10026 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
10027 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
10028 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
10035 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
10038 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
10039 their <tt>Provides</tt> control field that they provide the
10040 virtual package <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also
10041 register themselves as an alternative for
10042 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
10043 calculated as follows:
10044 <list compact="compact">
10046 Start with a priority of 20.
10050 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
10051 system, add 20 points if this support is available
10052 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
10053 configuration files belonging to the system or user
10054 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
10055 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
10061 If the window manager complies with <url
10062 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec"
10063 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
10064 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/"
10065 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
10069 If the window manager permits the X session to be
10070 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
10071 (without killing the X server) in its default
10072 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
10075 That alternative should have a slave alternative
10076 for <file>/usr/share/man/man1/x-window-manager.1.gz</file>
10077 pointing to the corresponding manual page.
10082 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
10085 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
10087 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
10088 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
10089 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
10090 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
10091 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
10092 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
10095 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
10096 available without modification of the X or font server
10097 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
10098 other font packages to register information about
10102 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
10103 must be in a separate binary package from any
10104 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
10105 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
10106 license information). If one or more of the fonts
10107 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
10108 the package with which they are associated the font
10109 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
10110 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
10111 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
10112 packages.<footnote>
10113 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
10114 from the local file system or over the network
10115 from an X font server; the Debian package system
10116 is empowered to deal only with the local
10122 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
10123 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
10124 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
10125 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
10127 <list compact="compact">
10129 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
10130 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
10134 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
10135 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
10139 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
10140 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
10141 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
10147 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
10148 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
10149 metric files are available, they must be placed here
10154 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
10155 other than those listed above must be neither
10156 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
10157 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
10158 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
10159 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
10163 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
10164 in the X font directories listed above, provide
10165 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
10166 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
10167 a location must comply with the FHS.
10171 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
10172 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
10173 they should be provided in separate binary packages
10174 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
10175 the names of the packages containing the
10176 corresponding fonts.
10180 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
10181 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
10182 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
10183 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
10188 Font packages must not provide the files
10189 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
10190 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
10193 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
10197 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
10198 files, if needed, should be provided in the
10200 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
10201 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
10203 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
10204 package's corresponding fonts are stored
10205 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
10206 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
10207 that provides these fonts, and
10208 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
10209 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
10216 Font packages must declare a dependency on
10217 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their <tt>Depends</tt>
10218 or <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> control field.
10222 Font packages that provide one or more
10223 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
10224 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
10225 directory into which they installed fonts
10226 <em>before</em> invoking
10227 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
10228 This invocation must occur in both the
10229 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
10230 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
10231 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
10235 Font packages that provide one or more
10236 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
10237 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
10238 directory into which they installed fonts. This
10239 invocation must occur in both the
10240 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
10241 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
10242 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
10246 Font packages must invoke
10247 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
10248 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
10249 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
10250 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
10251 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
10255 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
10256 fonts they include which collide with alias names
10257 already in use by fonts already packaged.
10261 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
10262 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
10268 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
10269 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
10272 Application defaults files must be installed in the
10273 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
10274 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
10275 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
10276 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
10277 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
10278 configuration files.
10282 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
10283 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
10284 as that of the package placed in
10285 the <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which
10286 must be registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
10287 configuration file.<footnote>
10288 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
10289 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
10290 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
10291 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
10298 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
10301 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
10302 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
10303 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
10304 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
10305 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
10306 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
10307 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
10308 regarded as obsolete.
10312 Include files previously installed under
10313 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
10314 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
10315 installed into subdirectories of
10316 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
10317 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
10318 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
10319 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
10323 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
10324 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
10325 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
10326 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
10327 Other X Window System applications should use
10328 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
10329 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
10335 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
10338 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
10342 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
10343 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
10344 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
10345 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
10346 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
10351 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
10354 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
10355 package emacs lisp programs.
10359 The Emacs policy is available in
10360 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
10361 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
10362 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
10363 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
10364 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
10369 <heading>Games</heading>
10372 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
10373 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
10377 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
10380 Games which require protected, privileged access to
10381 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
10382 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
10383 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
10384 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
10385 example). They must not be made
10386 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
10387 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
10388 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
10389 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
10390 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
10391 important game data, and if they can get at the other
10392 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
10396 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
10397 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
10398 data files or other static information made unreadable so
10399 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
10400 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
10401 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
10402 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
10403 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
10404 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
10408 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
10409 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
10410 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
10411 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
10412 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
10418 <heading>Documentation</heading>
10421 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
10424 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
10425 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
10426 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
10427 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
10431 Each program, utility, and function should have an
10432 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
10433 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
10434 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
10435 auxiliary things are optional.
10439 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
10440 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
10441 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
10442 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
10443 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
10444 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
10445 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
10446 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
10447 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples created
10448 by <prgn>dh_make</prgn>, the helper
10449 program <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
10450 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
10455 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
10456 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
10457 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
10458 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
10459 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
10460 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
10465 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
10469 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
10470 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
10471 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
10472 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
10473 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
10474 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
10475 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
10476 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
10477 base of the man page tree (usually
10478 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
10479 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
10480 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
10481 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
10482 man page under those names based solely on the information in
10483 the man page's header.<footnote>
10484 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
10485 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
10486 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
10487 database that would be better left in the file system.
10488 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
10489 be present in the future.
10494 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
10495 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
10496 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
10497 to the shortest relevant locale name in
10498 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
10499 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
10500 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
10501 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
10502 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
10508 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
10509 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
10510 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
10511 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
10512 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
10513 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
10514 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
10519 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
10520 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
10521 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
10522 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
10523 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
10524 the original language instead of the target language.
10529 <heading>Info documents</heading>
10532 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
10533 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
10537 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
10538 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for the
10539 use of info readers. This file must not be included in packages
10540 other than <package>install-info</package>.
10544 <prgn>install-info</prgn> is automatically invoked when
10545 appropriate using dpkg triggers. Packages other than
10546 <package>install-info</package> <em>should not</em> invoke
10547 <prgn>install-info</prgn> directly and <em>should not</em>
10548 depend on, recommend, or suggest <package>install-info</package>
10553 Info readers requiring the <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> file
10554 should depend on <package>install-info</package>.
10558 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
10559 information in the document for the use
10560 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
10561 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
10562 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
10563 entries should be included between
10564 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
10565 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
10567 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
10568 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
10569 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
10572 To determine which section to use, you should look
10573 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
10574 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
10575 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
10576 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
10577 To include this information in the generated info document, if
10578 it is absent, add commands like:
10580 @dircategory Individual utilities
10582 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
10585 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
10586 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
10592 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
10595 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
10596 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
10597 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
10598 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
10599 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
10600 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
10604 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
10605 many users of the package will not require you should create
10606 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
10607 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
10608 or want it installed.</p>
10611 It is often a good idea to put text information files
10612 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
10613 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
10614 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
10615 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
10619 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
10620 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
10622 The system administrator should be able to
10623 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
10624 any programs to break.
10626 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
10627 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
10628 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
10629 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
10633 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
10634 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
10635 the two packages both come from the same source and the
10636 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
10638 Please note that this does not override the section on
10639 changelog files below, so the file
10640 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
10641 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
10642 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
10643 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
10644 symlink must be the same (same source package and
10651 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
10652 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
10653 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
10654 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
10655 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
10656 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
10657 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
10658 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
10664 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
10667 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
10671 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
10672 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
10673 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
10674 package, in the directory
10675 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
10676 its subdirectories.<footnote>
10677 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
10678 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
10679 necessarily in the main binary package.
10684 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
10685 package maintainer's discretion.
10689 <sect id="copyrightfile">
10690 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
10693 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
10694 copyright information and distribution license in the file
10695 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
10696 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
10700 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
10701 sources (if any) were obtained, and should name the original
10706 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
10707 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
10708 part of the Debian distribution and briefly explain why.
10712 A copy of the file which will be installed in
10713 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
10714 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
10718 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
10719 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
10720 the two packages both come from the same source and the
10721 first package Depends on the second. These rules are important
10722 because <file>copyright</file> files must be extractable by
10727 Packages distributed under the Apache license (version 2.0), the
10728 Artistic license, the GNU GPL (versions 1, 2, or 3), the GNU
10729 LGPL (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or
10730 1.3) should refer to the corresponding files
10731 under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
10734 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
10735 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
10736 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-1</file>,
10737 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
10738 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
10739 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
10740 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
10741 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
10742 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
10743 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
10744 respectively. The University of California BSD license is
10745 also included in <package>base-files</package> as
10746 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>, but given the
10747 brevity of this license, its specificity to code whose
10748 copyright is held by the Regents of the University of
10749 California, and the frequency of minor wording changes, its
10750 text should be included in the copyright file rather than
10751 referencing this file.
10753 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
10758 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
10759 file. If your package has such a file it should be
10760 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
10761 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.
10765 All copyright files must be encoded in UTF-8.
10768 <sect1 id="copyrightformat">
10769 <heading>Machine-readable copyright information</heading>
10772 A specification for a standard, machine-readable format
10773 for <file>debian/copyright</file> files is maintained as part
10774 of the <package>debian-policy</package> package. This
10775 document may be found in the <file>copyright-format</file>
10776 files in the <package>debian-policy</package> package. It is
10777 also available from the Debian web mirrors at
10778 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/copyright-format/1.0/"
10779 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/copyright-format/1.0/"></tt>.
10783 Use of this format is optional.
10789 <heading>Examples</heading>
10792 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
10793 should be installed in a directory
10794 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
10795 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
10796 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
10797 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
10798 should be installed in a directory
10799 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
10801 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
10802 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
10807 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
10808 example files may be installed into
10809 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
10813 <sect id="changelogs">
10814 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
10817 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
10818 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
10819 the Debian source tree in
10820 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
10821 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
10825 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
10826 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
10827 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
10828 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
10829 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
10830 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
10831 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
10832 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
10833 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
10834 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
10835 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
10836 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
10837 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
10838 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
10843 All of these files should be installed compressed using
10844 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
10845 if they start out small.
10849 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
10850 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
10851 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
10852 usually be installed as
10853 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
10854 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
10855 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
10856 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
10860 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
10861 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
10866 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
10867 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
10870 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
10871 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
10872 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
10873 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
10874 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
10875 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
10876 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
10877 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
10878 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
10879 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
10880 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
10884 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
10885 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
10886 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
10887 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
10888 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
10889 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
10890 done in due course.
10894 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
10895 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
10896 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
10900 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
10901 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
10903 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian, but may
10904 work on or be ported to other systems.
10909 The binary packages are designed for the management of
10910 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
10911 their associated data, though source code examples and
10912 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
10915 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
10916 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
10917 behavior of the package management programs
10918 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
10919 they interact with packages.</p>
10922 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
10923 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
10924 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
10929 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10930 not described in detail here, are documented in their man pages.
10934 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
10935 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
10936 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
10940 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided as
10941 an example for people wishing to create Debian packages. However,
10942 while the examples are helpful, they do not replace the need to
10943 read and follow the Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
10946 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
10947 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10950 See <manref name="deb" section="5"> and <ref id="pkg-controlarea">.
10953 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
10954 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
10958 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
10959 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
10960 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
10961 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
10962 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
10963 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
10968 In order to create a binary package you must make a
10969 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
10970 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
10971 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
10972 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
10977 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
10978 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
10979 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
10980 they are installed.
10984 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
10985 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
10986 used should be the same on the system where the package is
10987 built and the one where it is installed.
10991 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
10992 miniature file system tree you're creating:
10993 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
10994 information files, notably the binary package control file
10995 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
10999 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
11000 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
11001 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is unpacked.
11005 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
11007 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
11012 This will build the package in
11013 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
11014 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
11015 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
11016 build the package.)
11020 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
11021 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
11022 output of following commands enlightening:
11024 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
11025 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
11026 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
11028 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
11030 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
11035 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
11036 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
11039 The control information portion of a binary package is a
11040 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
11041 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
11042 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
11043 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
11044 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
11048 It is possible to put other files in the package control
11049 information file area, but this is not generally a good idea
11050 (though they will largely be ignored).
11054 Here is a brief list of the control information files supported
11055 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
11060 <tag><tt>control</tt>
11063 This is the key description file used by
11064 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
11065 and version, gives its description for the user,
11066 states its relationships with other packages, and so
11067 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
11068 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
11072 It is usually generated automatically from information
11073 in the source package by the
11074 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
11075 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
11076 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
11080 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
11085 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
11086 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
11087 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
11088 deal with matters which are particular to that package
11089 or require more complicated processing than that
11090 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
11091 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
11095 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
11096 See <ref id="idempotency">.
11100 The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a
11101 controlling terminal and may not be able to interact with
11102 the user. See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
11106 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
11109 This file contains a list of configuration files which
11110 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
11111 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
11112 every configuration file should be listed here.
11115 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
11118 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
11119 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
11120 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
11121 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
11122 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
11123 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
11128 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
11129 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
11132 The most important control information file used by
11133 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
11134 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
11139 The binary package control files of packages built from
11140 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
11141 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
11142 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
11143 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
11148 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
11149 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
11153 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
11154 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
11159 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
11162 See <ref id="timestamps">.
11167 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
11168 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
11171 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
11172 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
11173 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
11176 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
11177 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
11180 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
11181 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
11182 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
11186 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
11187 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
11188 documentation about their arguments and operation.
11192 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
11193 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
11194 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
11198 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
11200 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
11205 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
11206 called from package-independent automated building scripts
11207 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
11211 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
11213 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
11218 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
11219 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
11220 the same directory. It unpacks into
11221 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
11223 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
11224 the current directory.
11228 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
11230 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
11235 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
11236 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
11237 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
11238 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
11243 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
11247 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
11249 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
11254 See <manref name="dpkg-buildpackage" section="1">.
11258 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
11260 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
11265 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
11266 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
11271 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
11272 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
11273 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
11274 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
11276 This is so that the control file which is produced has
11277 the right permissions
11282 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
11283 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
11284 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
11285 the installed size of a package is correct.
11289 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
11290 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
11291 variable substitutions created by
11292 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
11297 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
11298 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
11299 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
11300 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
11304 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
11307 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
11308 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
11309 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
11310 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
11311 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
11315 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
11316 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
11317 (for example) a future invocation of
11318 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
11321 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
11323 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
11328 See <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
11332 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
11334 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
11335 <file>debian/files</file>
11339 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
11340 the source and binary package files.
11344 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
11345 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
11346 the <file>.changes</file> file when
11347 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
11351 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
11352 <file>debian/rules</file>:
11354 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
11356 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
11357 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
11358 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
11359 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
11360 file there just before or just after calling
11361 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
11365 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
11366 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
11371 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
11373 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
11374 upload control file
11378 See <manref name="dpkg-genchanges" section="1">.
11382 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
11384 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
11385 representation of a changelog
11389 See <manref name="dpkg-parsechangelog" section="1">.
11393 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
11395 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
11400 See <manref name="dpkg-architecture" section="1">.
11405 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
11406 <heading>The Debian package source tree</heading>
11409 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
11410 allow a Debian package source tree with some associated
11411 control information to be reproduced and transported easily.
11412 The Debian package source tree is a version of the original
11413 program with certain files added for the benefit of the
11414 packaging process, and with any other changes required
11415 made to the rest of the source code and installation
11420 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
11421 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debian package
11422 source tree. They are described below.
11425 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
11426 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
11429 See <ref id="debianrules">.
11433 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
11434 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
11437 See <ref id="substvars">.
11443 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
11446 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
11450 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
11454 This is the canonical temporary location for the
11455 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
11456 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
11457 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
11458 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
11459 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
11460 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
11461 id="pkg-bincreating">.
11465 If several binary packages are generated from the same
11466 source tree it is usual to use several
11467 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
11468 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
11472 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
11473 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
11474 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
11478 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
11482 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
11483 consists of three related files. You must have the right
11484 versions of all three to be able to use them.
11489 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
11491 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
11492 to extract a source package.
11493 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
11497 Original source archive -
11499 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
11505 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
11506 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
11507 the upstream authors of the program.
11512 Debian package diff -
11514 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
11520 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
11521 giving the changes which are required to turn the
11522 original source into the Debian source. These changes
11523 may only include editing and creating plain files.
11524 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
11525 links and the characteristics of special files or
11526 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
11531 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
11532 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
11533 tree, which will be created by
11534 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
11538 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
11539 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
11540 executable (see below).</p></item>
11545 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
11546 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
11547 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
11548 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
11550 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
11551 and preferably contains a directory named
11552 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
11557 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
11560 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
11561 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
11562 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
11563 <enumlist compact="compact">
11566 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
11570 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
11571 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
11575 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
11576 the source tree.</p>
11578 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
11580 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
11581 source code alongside the Debian version.</p>
11586 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
11587 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
11588 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
11589 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
11593 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
11596 The source package may not contain any hard links
11598 This is not currently detected when building source
11599 packages, but only when extracting
11603 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
11604 future, but would require a fair amount of
11606 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
11609 Setgid directories are allowed.
11614 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
11615 original and Debian source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
11616 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
11617 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the Debian
11618 package source must not involve any changes which cannot be
11619 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
11620 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
11621 building the source package are:
11622 <list compact="compact">
11623 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
11625 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
11627 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
11629 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
11630 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
11631 print a warning but continue anyway are:
11632 <list compact="compact">
11635 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
11637 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
11638 seen as the removal of the old file (which
11639 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
11640 and the creation of the new one.
11646 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
11647 newline (either in the original or the modified
11652 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
11653 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
11654 <list compact="compact">
11655 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
11656 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
11661 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
11662 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
11663 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
11664 directory, and afterwards it will make
11665 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
11671 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
11672 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
11675 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
11676 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
11677 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
11678 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
11679 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
11684 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
11687 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
11691 It is important to note that there are several fields which
11692 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
11693 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
11694 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
11699 <heading>List of fields</heading>
11702 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
11706 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
11707 to the Policy manual.
11710 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
11711 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
11714 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
11715 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
11716 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
11717 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
11718 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
11723 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
11724 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
11727 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
11728 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
11729 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
11730 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
11731 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
11736 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
11737 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
11740 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
11741 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
11742 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
11743 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
11744 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
11749 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
11750 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
11753 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
11754 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
11755 version of the package which was successfully
11760 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
11761 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
11764 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
11765 information about the automatically-managed configuration
11766 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
11767 appear anywhere in a package!
11772 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
11775 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
11776 not appear anywhere any more.
11778 <taglist compact="compact">
11780 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
11781 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
11782 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
11784 The Debian revision part of the package version was
11785 at one point in a separate control field. This
11786 field went through several names.
11789 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
11790 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
11792 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
11793 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
11795 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
11796 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
11805 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
11806 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
11809 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
11810 handling of package configuration files.
11814 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
11815 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
11816 particular configuration file.
11820 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
11821 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
11822 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
11823 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
11824 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
11825 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
11829 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
11830 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
11831 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
11832 versions of the package automatically. This will be
11833 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
11837 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
11842 A package may contain a control information file called
11843 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
11844 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
11845 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
11846 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
11851 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
11852 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
11853 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
11858 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
11859 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
11860 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
11861 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
11862 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
11867 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
11868 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
11869 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
11870 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
11871 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
11872 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
11873 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
11874 installed (with an informative message). If both have
11875 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
11876 and must resolve the differences themselves.
11880 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
11881 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
11882 was included in the most recent version of the package.
11886 When a package is installed for the first time
11887 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
11888 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
11893 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
11894 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
11895 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
11896 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
11897 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
11898 kept that way if the user did it.
11902 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
11903 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
11904 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
11905 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
11906 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
11909 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
11914 For files which contain site-specific information such as
11915 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
11916 better to create the file in the package's
11917 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
11921 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
11922 of the system to determine values and other information, and
11923 may involve prompting the user for some information which
11924 can't be obtained some other way.
11928 When using this method there are a couple of important
11929 issues which should be considered:
11933 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
11934 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
11935 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
11936 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
11937 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
11938 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
11939 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
11940 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
11941 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
11942 deal with them correctly.
11946 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
11947 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
11948 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
11949 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
11950 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
11951 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
11952 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
11953 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
11954 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
11955 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
11956 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
11957 overwrite it.</p></sect>
11960 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
11961 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
11966 When several packages all provide different versions of the
11967 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
11968 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
11969 and have their decisions respected.
11973 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
11974 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
11975 being installed at once, each under their own name
11976 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
11977 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
11978 refer to something, at least by default.
11982 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
11983 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
11987 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
11988 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
11989 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
11994 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
11995 section="8"> for details.
11999 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
12000 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
12003 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
12004 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
12008 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
12009 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
12010 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
12014 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
12015 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
12016 provide a wrapper for it).
12020 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
12021 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
12022 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
12026 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
12027 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
12028 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
12029 details of its operation.
12033 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
12034 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
12035 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
12036 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
12037 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
12039 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
12040 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
12041 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
12042 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
12043 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
12044 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
12045 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
12046 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
12047 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
12048 the package is being upgraded:
12050 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
12051 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
12052 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
12054 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
12055 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
12056 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
12060 The postrm has to do the reverse:
12062 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
12063 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
12064 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
12066 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
12067 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
12068 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
12069 upgrades are no longer supported):
12071 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
12072 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
12073 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
12075 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
12076 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
12077 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
12078 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
12079 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
12080 the diversion will fail.
12084 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
12085 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
12086 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
12087 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
12088 does not exist.</p>
12091 Do not attempt to divert a conffile, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not
12098 <!-- Local variables: -->
12099 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
12101 <!-- vim:set ai sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->